blob: adfb26f9c609bc469eeaadd36a9f35b353e3649b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8747b6d2015-03-11 23:57:23 +01007 2015/03/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020053
544. Proxies
554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
564.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
57
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200585. Bind and Server options
595.1. Bind options
605.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020061
626. HTTP header manipulation
63
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200647. Using ACLs and fetching samples
657.1. ACL basics
667.1.1. Matching booleans
677.1.2. Matching integers
687.1.3. Matching strings
697.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
707.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
717.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
727.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
737.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200747.3.1. Converters
757.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
767.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
777.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
787.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
797.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200807.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081
828. Logging
838.1. Log levels
848.2. Log formats
858.2.1. Default log format
868.2.2. TCP log format
878.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100888.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100898.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200908.3. Advanced logging options
918.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
928.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
938.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
948.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
958.4. Timing events
968.5. Session state at disconnection
978.6. Non-printable characters
988.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
998.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1008.9. Examples of logs
101
1029. Statistics and monitoring
1039.1. CSV format
1049.2. Unix Socket commands
105
106
1071. Quick reminder about HTTP
108----------------------------
109
110When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
111fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
112on almost anything found in the contents.
113
114However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
115formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
116correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
117
118
1191.1. The HTTP transaction model
120-------------------------------
121
122The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100123to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
125connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
126will involve a new connection :
127
128 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
129
130In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
131establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
132by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
133length.
134
135Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
136to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
137however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
138response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
139header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
144power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
145but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200146a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147
148A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
149keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
150second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
151page :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
156latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
157correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
158the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100159server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100161By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
162connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
163leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
164start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
167 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
168 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
169 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
170 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
171 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
172 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174
1751.2. HTTP request
176-----------------
177
178First, let's consider this HTTP request :
179
180 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100181 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
183 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
184 3 User-agent: my small browser
185 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
186 5 Accept: image/png
187
188
1891.2.1. The Request line
190-----------------------
191
192Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
193
194 - a METHOD : GET
195 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
197
198All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
199which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
200followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
201is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
202desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
203the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
204
205The URI itself can have several forms :
206
207 - A "relative URI" :
208
209 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
210
211 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
212 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
213
214 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
215
216 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
217
218 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
219 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
220 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
221 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
222 must accept this form too.
223
224 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
225 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
226 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
229 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
230 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
231 other protocols too.
232
233In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
234mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
235on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
236It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
237specific to the language, framework or application in use.
238
239
2401.2.2. The request headers
241--------------------------
242
243The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
244beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
245an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
246Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
247values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
248encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
249the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
250define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
251
252Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
253their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
254"Connection:" header).
255
256The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
257that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
258is one valid form of empty line.
259
260Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
261headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
262about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
263application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
264
265Important note:
266 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
267 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
268 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
269 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
270
271
2721.3. HTTP response
273------------------
274
275An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
276messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
277
278 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100279 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
281 2 Content-length: 350
282 3 Content-Type: text/html
283
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
285codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
286response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100287continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
288the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
289following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
290sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
291(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
292correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
293such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
294state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
295over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
296if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
297information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
3001.3.1. The Response line
301------------------------
302
303Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
304
305 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
306 - a status code : 200
307 - a reason : OK
308
309The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200310 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
312 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
313 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
314 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
315
316Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
319messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
320or "Authentication Required".
321
322Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
323
324 Code When / reason
325 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
326 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
327 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100329 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331 400 for an invalid or too large request
332 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
333 accessing the stats page)
334 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
335 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
336 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
337 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
338 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
339 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
340 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
341 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
342 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
343
344The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3454.2).
346
347
3481.3.2. The response headers
349---------------------------
350
351Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
352the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
353details.
354
355
3562. Configuring HAProxy
357----------------------
358
3592.1. Configuration file format
360------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200361
362HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
363
364 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
365 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
366 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
367 "frontend" and "backend".
368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
370referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200371delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003742.2. Quoting and escaping
375-------------------------
376
377HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
378many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
379with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
380single quotes.
381
382If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
383them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
384escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
385
386Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
387
388 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
389 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
390 \\ to use a backslash
391 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
392 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
393
394Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
395the interpretation of:
396
397 space as a parameter separator
398 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
399 # hash as a comment start
400
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200401Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
402-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
403backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
404
405Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200406quoting.
407
408Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
409nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
410
411Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
412equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
413
414 Example:
415 # those are equivalents:
416 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
417 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
418 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
419 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
421
422 # those are equivalents:
423 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
424 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
425 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
426 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
427
428
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004292.3. Environment variables
430--------------------------
431
432HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
433interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
434configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
435optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
436shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
437underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
438
439 Example:
440
441 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
442
443 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
444
445 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
446
447
4482.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200449----------------
450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100451Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100452values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
453otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
454numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
455for every keyword. Supported units are :
456
457 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
458 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
459 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
460 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
461 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
462 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
463
464
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004652.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200466-------------
467
468 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
469 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
470 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
471 global
472 daemon
473 maxconn 256
474
475 defaults
476 mode http
477 timeout connect 5000ms
478 timeout client 50000ms
479 timeout server 50000ms
480
481 frontend http-in
482 bind *:80
483 default_backend servers
484
485 backend servers
486 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
487
488
489 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
490 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
491 global
492 daemon
493 maxconn 256
494
495 defaults
496 mode http
497 timeout connect 5000ms
498 timeout client 50000ms
499 timeout server 50000ms
500
501 listen http-in
502 bind *:80
503 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
504
505
506Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
507
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100508 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200509
510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005113. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200512--------------------
513
514Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
515are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
516of them have command-line equivalents.
517
518The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
519
520 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200522 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200523 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200524 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900525 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - gid
527 - group
528 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100529 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - nbproc
531 - pidfile
532 - uid
533 - ulimit-n
534 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200535 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100536 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200537 - node
538 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100539 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200541 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200542 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200544 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100545 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100546 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100547 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200548 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200549 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200550 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200551 - noepoll
552 - nokqueue
553 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100554 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300555 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200556 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200557 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200558 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100559 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100560 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200561 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100562 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100563 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100564 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100565 - tune.lua.session-timeout
566 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100567 - tune.maxaccept
568 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200569 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200570 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200571 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100572 - tune.rcvbuf.client
573 - tune.rcvbuf.server
574 - tune.sndbuf.client
575 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100576 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100577 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200578 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100579 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200580 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100581 - tune.zlib.memlevel
582 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100583
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 * Debugging
585 - debug
586 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587
588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005893.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590------------------------------------
591
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200592ca-base <dir>
593 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200594 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
595 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200596
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597chroot <jail dir>
598 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
599 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
600 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
601 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
602 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
603 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100604
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100605cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
606 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
607 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
608 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100609 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
610 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
611 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
612 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
613 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
614 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
615 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
616 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
617 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
618 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100619
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200620crt-base <dir>
621 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
622 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
623 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
624
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625daemon
626 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
627 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
628 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
629
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200630deviceatlas-json-file <path>
631 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
632 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
633
634deviceatlas-log-level <value>
635 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
636 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
637
638deviceatlas-separator <char>
639 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
640 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
641
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900642external-check
643 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
644 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
645 See "option external-check".
646
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647gid <number>
648 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
649 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
650 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100651 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
652 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200653 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100654
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200655group <group name>
656 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
657 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100658
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200659log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
661 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100662 configured with "log global".
663
664 <address> can be one of:
665
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100666 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100667 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
668 port).
669
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100670 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
671 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
672 port).
673
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100674 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
675 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
676 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
677 writeable).
678
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200679 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
680 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100681
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200682 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
683 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
684 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
685 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
686 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
687 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
688 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
689 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
690 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
691 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
692 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
693
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100694 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695
696 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
697 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
698 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
699
700 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200701 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
702 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
703 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
704 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
705 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
706 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200708 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200709
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100710log-send-hostname [<string>]
711 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
712 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
713 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
714 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
715 the logs.
716
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000717log-tag <string>
718 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
719 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
720 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100721 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000722
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100723lua-load <file>
724 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
725 used multiple times.
726
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200727nbproc <number>
728 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
729 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
730 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
731 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
732 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
733
734pidfile <pidfile>
735 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
736 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
737 starting the process. See also "daemon".
738
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100739stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200740 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
741 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
742 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
743 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
744 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
745 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100746 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200747 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
748 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200749
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100750ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
751 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
752 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300753 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100754 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
755 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
756 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
757 "bind" keyword for more information.
758
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100759ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
761 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
762 keyword to see available options.
763
764 Example:
765 global
766 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
767
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100768ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
769 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
770 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300771 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100772 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
773 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
774 information.
775
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100776ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
777 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
778 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
779 keyword to see available options.
780
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200781ssl-dh-param-file <file>
782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
783 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
784 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
785 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
786 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
787 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them directly
788 in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size specified
789 by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are known to be
790 more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
791 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
792 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
793 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
794
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100795ssl-server-verify [none|required]
796 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
797 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
798 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
799
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200800stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
801 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
802 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
803 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
804 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200805
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200806 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
807 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
808 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200809
810stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
811 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
812 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100813 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200814
815stats maxconn <connections>
816 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
817 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819uid <number>
820 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
821 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
822 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
823 one. See also "gid" and "user".
824
825ulimit-n <number>
826 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
827 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
828 option.
829
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100830unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
831 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
832
833 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
834 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
835 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
836 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
837 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
838 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
839 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
840 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
841 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
842 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
843
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200844user <user name>
845 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
846 See also "uid" and "group".
847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200848node <name>
849 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
850
851 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
852 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
853 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
854 traffic.
855
856description <text>
857 Add a text that describes the instance.
858
859 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
860 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
861 "<" and ">" characters.
862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008643.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200865-----------------------
866
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200867max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
868 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
869 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
870 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
871 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
872 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
873 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
874 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
875 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
876
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877maxconn <number>
878 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
879 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
880 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200881 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
882 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
883 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
884 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100885 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
886 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
887 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
888 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
889 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200890
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200891maxconnrate <number>
892 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
893 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
894 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
895 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
896 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
897 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
898 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
899 fairness.
900
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100901maxcomprate <number>
902 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300903 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100904 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
905 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
906 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
907 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
908 default value.
909
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100910maxcompcpuusage <number>
911 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
912 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
913 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
914 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
915 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
916 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
917 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
918 process down and from introducing high latencies.
919
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100920maxpipes <number>
921 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
922 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
923 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
924 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
925 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
926 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
927
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200928maxsessrate <number>
929 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
930 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
931 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
932 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
933 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
934 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
935 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
936 fairness.
937
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200938maxsslconn <number>
939 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
940 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
941 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
942 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
943 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
944 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
945 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100946 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
947 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
948 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
949 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
950 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
951 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
952 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200953
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200954maxsslrate <number>
955 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
956 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
957 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
958 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
959 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
960 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
961 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
962 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
963 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
964 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
965
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100966maxzlibmem <number>
967 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
968 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
969 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100970 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
971 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
972 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
973
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974noepoll
975 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
976 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100977 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200978
979nokqueue
980 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
981 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
982 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
983
984nopoll
985 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
986 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100987 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100988 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200989
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100990nosplice
991 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
992 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
993 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100994 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100995 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
996 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
997 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
998 "option splice-response".
999
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001000nogetaddrinfo
1001 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1002 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1003
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001004spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001005 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1006 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1007 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1008 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1009 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1010 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001011
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001012tune.buffers.limit <number>
1013 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1014 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1015 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1016 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1017 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1018 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1019 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1020 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1021 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1022 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1023 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1024 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1025 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1026 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1027 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1028
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001029tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1030 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1031 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1032 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1033 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1034
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001035tune.bufsize <number>
1036 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1037 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1038 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1039 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1040 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1041 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1042 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1043 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001044 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1045 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1046 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001047
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001048tune.chksize <number>
1049 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1050 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1051 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1052 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1053 checks whenever possible.
1054
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001055tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1056 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1057 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1058 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1059 this value. The default value is 1.
1060
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001061tune.http.cookielen <number>
1062 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1063 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1064 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1065 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1066 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1067 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1068 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1069 to change this value.
1070
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001071tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1072 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1073 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1074 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1075 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1076 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1077 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1078 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1079 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1080 limit too high.
1081
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001082tune.idletimer <timeout>
1083 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1084 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1085 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1086 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1087 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1088 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1089 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1090 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1091 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1092
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001093tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1094 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1095 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1096 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1097 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1098 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1099 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1100 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1101
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001102tune.lua.maxmem
1103 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1104 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1105 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1106 memory.
1107
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001108tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1109 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1110 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1111 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1112 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1113 4s.
1114
1115tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1116 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1117 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1118 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1119 check servers.
1120
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001121tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001122 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1123 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1124 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1125 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1126 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1127 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1128 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1129 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1130 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1131 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001132
1133tune.maxpollevents <number>
1134 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1135 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1136 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1137 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1138 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1139
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001140tune.maxrewrite <number>
1141 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1142 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1143 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1144 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1145 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1146 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1147 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1148 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1149 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1150 bufsize.
1151
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001152tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1153 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1154 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1155 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1156 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1157 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1158 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1159 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1160 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1161 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1162 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1163 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1164 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1165 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1166 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1167 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1168 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1169 setting this parameter to 0.
1170
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001171tune.pipesize <number>
1172 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1173 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1174 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1175 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1176 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1177 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1178
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001179tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1180tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1181 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1182 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1183 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1184 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1185 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1186 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1187 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1188
1189tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1190tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1191 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1192 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1193 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1194 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1195 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1196 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1197 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1198 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1199 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1200 notifying haproxy again.
1201
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001202tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001203 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1204 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1205 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001206 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001207 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1208 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1209 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1210 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1211 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001212 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1213 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001214
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001215tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1216 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1217 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1218 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1219 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1220 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1221 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1222
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001223tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1224 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001225 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001226 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1227 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1228 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1229 being used for too long.
1230
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001231tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1232 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1233 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1234 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1235 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1236 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1237 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1238 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1239 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1240 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1241 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001242 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1243 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001244
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001245tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1246 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1247 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1248 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1249 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1250 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1251 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1252 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001253 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1254 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001255
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001256tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1257 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001258 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001259 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1260 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1261 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1262
1263tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1264 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1265 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1266 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1267 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001268
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012693.3. Debugging
1270--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001271
1272debug
1273 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1274 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1275 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1276 system startup.
1277
1278quiet
1279 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1280 line argument "-q".
1281
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012833.4. Userlists
1284--------------
1285It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1286http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1287it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1288
1289userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001290 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001291 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1292
1293group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001294 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001295 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1296 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1297
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001298user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1299 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001300 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1301 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001302 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1303 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001304 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001305 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001306
1307
1308 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001309 userlist L1
1310 group G1 users tiger,scott
1311 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001312
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001313 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1314 user scott insecure-password elgato
1315 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001316
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001317 userlist L2
1318 group G1
1319 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001320
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001321 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1322 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1323 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001324
1325 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001326
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001327
13283.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001329----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001330It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1331haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1332pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1333identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1334or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1335Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1336known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1337the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1338process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1339during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1340tables.
1341
1342peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001343 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001344 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1345
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001346disabled
1347 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1348 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1349 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1350
1351enable
1352 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1353
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001354peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1355 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1356 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1357 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1358 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1359 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1360 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1361
1362 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1363 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1364
1365 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1366 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1367 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1368 across all peers.
1369
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001370 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1371 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001372
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001373 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001374 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001375 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1376 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1377 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001378
1379 backend mybackend
1380 mode tcp
1381 balance roundrobin
1382 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1383 stick on src
1384
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001385 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1386 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001387
1388
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090013893.6. Mailers
1390------------
1391It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1392If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1393in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1394
1395mailer <mailersect>
1396 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1397 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1398
1399mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1400 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1401
1402 Example:
1403 mailers mymailers
1404 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1405 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1406
1407 backend mybackend
1408 mode tcp
1409 balance roundrobin
1410
1411 email-alert mailers mymailers
1412 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1413 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1414
1415 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1416 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1417
1418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014194. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001420----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001421
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001422Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001423 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001424 - frontend <name>
1425 - backend <name>
1426 - listen <name>
1427
1428A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1429its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1430section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001431section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001432
1433A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1434connections.
1435
1436A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1437to forward incoming connections.
1438
1439A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1440parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1441
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001442All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1443'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1444case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1445
1446Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1447logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1448proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1449However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1450name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1451
1452Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1453and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001454bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001455protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1456modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1457arbitrary criteria.
1458
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001459In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1460a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1461the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1462
1463 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1464 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1465 between responses and new requests.
1466
1467 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1468 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1469 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1470 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1471
1472 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1473 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1474 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1475
1476 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1477 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1478 client-facing connection remains open.
1479
1480 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1481 after the end of the response.
1482
1483The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1484frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1485following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1486weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1487
1488 Backend mode
1489
1490 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1491 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1492 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1493 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1494 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1495 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1496 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1497 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1498 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1499 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1500 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001502
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015044.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1505--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001507The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1508limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1509they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1510limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001511marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001512option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001513and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1514with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1515specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001517
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001518 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1519------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1520acl - X X X
1521appsession - - X X
1522backlog X X X -
1523balance X - X X
1524bind - X X -
1525bind-process X X X X
1526block - X X X
1527capture cookie - X X -
1528capture request header - X X -
1529capture response header - X X -
1530clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001531compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001532contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1533cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001534declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001535default-server X - X X
1536default_backend X X X -
1537description - X X X
1538disabled X X X X
1539dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001540email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001541email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001542email-alert mailers X X X X
1543email-alert myhostname X X X X
1544email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001545enabled X X X X
1546errorfile X X X X
1547errorloc X X X X
1548errorloc302 X X X X
1549-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1550errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001551force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001552fullconn X - X X
1553grace X X X X
1554hash-type X - X X
1555http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001556http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001557http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001558http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001559http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001560http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001561id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001562ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001563log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001564log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001565log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001566max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001567maxconn X X X -
1568mode X X X X
1569monitor fail - X X -
1570monitor-net X X X -
1571monitor-uri X X X -
1572option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1573option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1574option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1575option allbackups (*) X - X X
1576option checkcache (*) X - X X
1577option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1578option contstats (*) X X X -
1579option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1580option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1581option forceclose (*) X X X X
1582-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1583option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001584option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001585option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001586option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001587option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001588option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001589option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001590option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001591option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1592option httpchk X - X X
1593option httpclose (*) X X X X
1594option httplog X X X X
1595option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001596option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001597option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001598option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001599option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1600option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1601option logasap (*) X X X -
1602option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001603option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001604option nolinger (*) X X X X
1605option originalto X X X X
1606option persist (*) X - X X
1607option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001608option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001609option smtpchk X - X X
1610option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1611option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1612option splice-request (*) X X X X
1613option splice-response (*) X X X X
1614option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1615option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1616-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001617option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001618option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1619option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1620option tcpka X X X X
1621option tcplog X X X X
1622option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001623external-check command X - X X
1624external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001625persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1626rate-limit sessions X X X -
1627redirect - X X X
1628redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1629redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1630reqadd - X X X
1631reqallow - X X X
1632reqdel - X X X
1633reqdeny - X X X
1634reqiallow - X X X
1635reqidel - X X X
1636reqideny - X X X
1637reqipass - X X X
1638reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001639reqitarpit - X X X
1640reqpass - X X X
1641reqrep - X X X
1642-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001643reqtarpit - X X X
1644retries X - X X
1645rspadd - X X X
1646rspdel - X X X
1647rspdeny - X X X
1648rspidel - X X X
1649rspideny - X X X
1650rspirep - X X X
1651rsprep - X X X
1652server - - X X
1653source X - X X
1654srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001655stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001656stats auth X - X X
1657stats enable X - X X
1658stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001659stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001660stats realm X - X X
1661stats refresh X - X X
1662stats scope X - X X
1663stats show-desc X - X X
1664stats show-legends X - X X
1665stats show-node X - X X
1666stats uri X - X X
1667-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1668stick match - - X X
1669stick on - - X X
1670stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001671stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001672stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001673tcp-check connect - - X X
1674tcp-check expect - - X X
1675tcp-check send - - X X
1676tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001677tcp-request connection - X X -
1678tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001679tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001680tcp-response content - - X X
1681tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001682timeout check X - X X
1683timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001684timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001685timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1686timeout connect X - X X
1687timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1688timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1689timeout http-request X X X X
1690timeout queue X - X X
1691timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001692timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001693timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1694timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001695timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001696transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001697unique-id-format X X X -
1698unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001699use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001700use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001701------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1702 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001703
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017054.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1706---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001707
1708This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1709
1710
1711acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1712 Declare or complete an access list.
1713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1714 no | yes | yes | yes
1715 Example:
1716 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1717 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1718 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001720 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721
1722
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001723appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1724 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001725 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1727 no | no | yes | yes
1728 Arguments :
1729 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1730 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1731
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001732 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733 checked in each cookie value.
1734
1735 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1736 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1737 milliseconds.
1738
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001739 request-learn
1740 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1741 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1742 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1743 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1744 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1745 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1746
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001747 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1748 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1749 data following this prefix.
1750
1751 Example :
1752 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1753
1754 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1755 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1756
1757 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1758 2 modes are currently supported :
1759 - path-parameters :
1760 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1761 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1762 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1763 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1764 - query-string :
1765 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1766 query string.
1767
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001768 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1769 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1770 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1771 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001772 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1773 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1774 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001775 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1776 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1777
1778 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1779
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001780 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1781 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1782 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1783
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001784 Example :
1785 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1786
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001787 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1788 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789
1790
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001791backlog <conns>
1792 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1794 yes | yes | yes | no
1795 Arguments :
1796 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1797 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001798 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001799
1800 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1801 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1802 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1803 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1804 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1805 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1806 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1807 backlog parameter.
1808
1809 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1810 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1811 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1812
1813 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1814
1815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001816balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001817balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001818 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1820 yes | no | yes | yes
1821 Arguments :
1822 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1823 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1824 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1825 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1826
1827 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1828 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1829 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1830 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001831 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001832 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001833 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1834 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1835 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1836 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1837 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1838 it, so that you don't worry.
1839
1840 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1841 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1842 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1843 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1844 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1845 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1846 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1847 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001849 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1850 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1851 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1852 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1853 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1854 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1855 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1856 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1857
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001858 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001859 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001860 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1861 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001862 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001863 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1864 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1865 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1866 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1867 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001868 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1869 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1870 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1871 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1872 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1873 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001875 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1876 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1877 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1878 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1879 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1880 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1881 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1882 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001883 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001885 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1886 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1887 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001888
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001889 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1890 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1891 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1892 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1893 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1894 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1895 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1896 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1897 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1898 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1899 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1900 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001901
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001902 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001903 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1904 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1905 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1906 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1907 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1908 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1909 URIs start with a leading "/".
1910
1911 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1912 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1913 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1914 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1915
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001916 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001917 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1918
1919 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001920 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1921 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001922 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1923 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1924 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1925 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001926 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001927 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1928 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001929
1930 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1931 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1932 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1933 server will receive the request.
1934
1935 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1936 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1937 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1938 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1939 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001940 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1941 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1942 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001943
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001944 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1945 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1946 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1947 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1948 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001950 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001951 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1952 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1953 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1954
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001955 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1956 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1957 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1958
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001959 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001960 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001961 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1962 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1963 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1964 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1965 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1966 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001967 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001968 used instead.
1969
1970 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1971 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1972 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1973 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1974
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001975 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1976 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1977 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1978
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001979 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001980
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001981 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001982 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1983 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001984
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001985 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1986 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1987 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001988
1989 Examples :
1990 balance roundrobin
1991 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001992 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001993 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1994 balance hdr(host)
1995 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001996
1997 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1998 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002000 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002001 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2002 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2003 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2004 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2005
2006 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2007 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2008 defaults to 16 kB.
2009
2010 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2011 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2012
2013 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2014 Round Robin.
2015
2016 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2017 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2018 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2019 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2020
2021 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2022
2023 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002024 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002025 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2026 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2027 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002028
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002029 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
2030 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002031
2032
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002033bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2034bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2037 no | yes | yes | no
2038 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002039 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2040 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2041 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2042 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002043 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002044 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2045 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2046 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2047 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2048 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2049 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2050 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002051 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2052 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2053 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2054 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2055 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2056 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2057 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002058 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2059 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2060 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002061 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2062 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2063 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002064
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002065 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2066 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002067 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2068 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2069 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002070 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2071 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2072 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2073 the range.
2074
2075 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2076 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2077 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2078 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2079 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2080 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2081 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002082 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002083 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002085 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2086 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2087 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2088 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2089 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2090 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2091 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2092 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2093
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002094 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2095 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2096 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2097 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002098
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002099 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2100 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2101 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2102 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2103 in a frontend.
2104
2105 Example :
2106 listen http_proxy
2107 bind :80,:443
2108 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002109 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002110
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002111 listen http_https_proxy
2112 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002113 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002114
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002115 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2116 bind ipv6@:80
2117 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2118 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2119
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002120 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002121 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002122
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002123 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002124 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002125
2126
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002127bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002128 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2130 yes | yes | yes | yes
2131 Arguments :
2132 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2133 may be used to override a default value.
2134
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002135 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002136 option may be combined with other numbers.
2137
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002138 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002139 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2140 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2141 missing from all processes.
2142
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002143 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002144 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002145 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2146 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2147 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2148 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002149
2150 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2151 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2152 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2153 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2154 and 'even' instances.
2155
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002156 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2157 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2158 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2159 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002160
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002161 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2162 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2163
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002164 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2165 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2166 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2167
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002168 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2169 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2170
2171 Example :
2172 listen app_ip1
2173 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002174 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002175
2176 listen app_ip2
2177 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002178 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002179
2180 listen management
2181 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002182 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002183
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002184 listen management
2185 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2186 bind-process 1-4
2187
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002188 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002189
2190
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002191block { if | unless } <condition>
2192 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2194 no | yes | yes | yes
2195
2196 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2197 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002198 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002199 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2201 "block" statements per instance.
2202
2203 Example:
2204 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2205 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2206 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2207 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002209 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002210
2211
2212capture cookie <name> len <length>
2213 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2215 no | yes | yes | no
2216 Arguments :
2217 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2218 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2219 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2220 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2221 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2222
2223 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2224 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2225 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2226 right if it exceeds <length>.
2227
2228 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2229 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2230 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2231 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2232
2233 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2234 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2235 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2236
2237 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2238 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2239 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002240 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2241 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2242 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002243
2244 Example:
2245 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2246
2247 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002248 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002249
2250
2251capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002252 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2254 no | yes | yes | no
2255 Arguments :
2256 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002257 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002258 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2259 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2260 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2261
2262 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2263 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2264 it exceeds <length>.
2265
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002266 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002267 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2268 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002269 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2270 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2271 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2272 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002273 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002274 environments to find where the request came from.
2275
2276 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2277 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2278 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2279 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002280
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002281 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2282 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2283 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2284 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2285 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002286
2287 Example:
2288 capture request header Host len 15
2289 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2290 capture request header Referrer len 15
2291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002292 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002293 about logging.
2294
2295
2296capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002297 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2299 no | yes | yes | no
2300 Arguments :
2301 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002302 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002303 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2304 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2305 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2306
2307 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2308 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2309 it exceeds <length>.
2310
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002311 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002312 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2313 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2314 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002315 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2316 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2317 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2318 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002319
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002320 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2321 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2322 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2323 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2324 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002325
2326 Example:
2327 capture response header Content-length len 9
2328 capture response header Location len 15
2329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002330 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002331 about logging.
2332
2333
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002334clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002335 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2337 yes | yes | yes | no
2338 Arguments :
2339 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2340 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2341 as explained at the top of this document.
2342
2343 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2344 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2345 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2346 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2347 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2348 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2349 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2350 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002351 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2353 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2354
2355 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2356 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2357 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2358 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2359 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2360 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2361
2362 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2363 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2364
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002365 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2366 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002367
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002368compression algo <algorithm> ...
2369compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002370compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002371 Enable HTTP compression.
2372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2373 yes | yes | yes | yes
2374 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002375 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2376 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2377 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2378
2379 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002380 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2381 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2382 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002383
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002384 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2385 support for zlib was built in.
2386
2387 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2388 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2389 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2390 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2391 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2392 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002393
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002394 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2395 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2396 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2397 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2398 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2399 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2400 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2401 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002402
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002403 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002404 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002405 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2406 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2407 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2408 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2409 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002410
2411 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2412 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2413 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2414 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2415 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002416 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2417 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2418 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2419 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2420 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002421 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2422 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002423
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002424 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002425 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2426 "Accept-Encoding" header
2427 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002428 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002429 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2430 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002431 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2432 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2433 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2434 "multipart"
2435 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2436 header
2437 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2438 and later
2439 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2440 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002441
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002442 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2443 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002444
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002445 Examples :
2446 compression algo gzip
2447 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002448
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002449contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002450 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2452 yes | no | yes | yes
2453 Arguments :
2454 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2455 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2456 as explained at the top of this document.
2457
2458 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002459 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002460 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2462 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2463 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2464 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2465
2466 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2467 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2468 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2469 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2470 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2471 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2472
2473 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2474 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2475 instead.
2476
2477 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2478 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2479
2480
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002481cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002482 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2483 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002484 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2486 yes | no | yes | yes
2487 Arguments :
2488 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2489 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2490 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2491 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2492 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2493 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2494 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2495 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2496 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2497
2498 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2499 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2500 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2501 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2502 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2503 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2504 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2505 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2506 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2507 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2508 "insert" and "prefix".
2509
2510 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002511 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002512
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002513 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002514 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2515 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2516 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2517 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2518 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2519 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2520 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2521 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2522 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2523 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002524
2525 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2526 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2527 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2528 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2529 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2530 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2531 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2532 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2533 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2534 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002535 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2536 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2537 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002538
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002539 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2540 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2541 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002542 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2543 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2544 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2545 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002546 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2547 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2548 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002549
2550 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2551 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2552 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2553 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2554 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2555 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2556 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2557 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2558 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2559
2560 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2561 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2562 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2563 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2564 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2565 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2566 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2567 persistence cookie in the cache.
2568 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2569
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002570 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2571 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2572 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2573 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2574 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2575 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2576 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2577 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2578 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2579 they logout.
2580
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002581 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2582 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2583 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2584 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2585
2586 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2587 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2588 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2589 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2590 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2591 this attribute.
2592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002593 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002594 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002595 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2596 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2597 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2598 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2599 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2600 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002601
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002602 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2603 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2604 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2605 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2606 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2607 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2608 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2609 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2610 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2611 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2612 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2613 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2614 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2615 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2616 the site.
2617
2618 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2619 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2620 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2621 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2622 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2623 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2624 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2625 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2626 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2627 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2628 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2629 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2630 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2631 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2632 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2633 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002635 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2636 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2637 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2638 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002639
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002640 Examples :
2641 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2642 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2643 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002644 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002645
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002646 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002647 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002648
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002649
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002650declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2651 Declares a capture slot.
2652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2653 no | yes | yes | no
2654 Arguments:
2655 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2656
2657 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2658 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2659 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2660 for use in the response.
2661
2662 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2663 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2664
2665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002666default-server [param*]
2667 Change default options for a server in a backend
2668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2669 yes | no | yes | yes
2670 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002671 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2672 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2673 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2674 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002675
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002676 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002677 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2678
2679 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002682default_backend <backend>
2683 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2685 yes | yes | yes | no
2686 Arguments :
2687 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2688
2689 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2690 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2691 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2692 will catch all undetermined requests.
2693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694 Example :
2695
2696 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2697 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2698 default_backend dynamic
2699
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002700 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002701
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002703description <string>
2704 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2706 no | yes | yes | yes
2707 Arguments : string
2708
2709 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2710 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2711 it describes.
2712 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2713
2714
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002715disabled
2716 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2718 yes | yes | yes | yes
2719 Arguments : none
2720
2721 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2722 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2723 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2724 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2725 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2726 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2727 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2728
2729 See also : "enabled"
2730
2731
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002732dispatch <address>:<port>
2733 Set a default server address
2734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2735 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002736 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002737
2738 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2739 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2740 during start-up.
2741
2742 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2743 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2744 possible with normal servers.
2745
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002746 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002747 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2748 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2749 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2750 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2751
2752 See also : "server"
2753
2754
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002755enabled
2756 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2758 yes | yes | yes | yes
2759 Arguments : none
2760
2761 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2762 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2763
2764 See also : "disabled"
2765
2766
2767errorfile <code> <file>
2768 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2770 yes | yes | yes | yes
2771 Arguments :
2772 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002773 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2774 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002775
2776 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002777 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002778 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002779 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2780 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002781
2782 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2783 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2784 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2785
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002786 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2787
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002788 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2789 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2790 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2791 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2792
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002793 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2794 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2795 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2796 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2797 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2798 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002800 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2801 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2802 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002803 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002804 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2805
2806 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2807
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002808 Example :
2809 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002810 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002811 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2812 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2813
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002814
2815errorloc <code> <url>
2816errorloc302 <code> <url>
2817 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2819 yes | yes | yes | yes
2820 Arguments :
2821 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002822 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002823
2824 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2825 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2826 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2827 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2828 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2829
2830 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2831 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2832 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2833
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002834 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2835
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002836 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2837 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2838 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2839 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2840 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2841 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2842 request.
2843
2844 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2845
2846
2847errorloc303 <code> <url>
2848 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2850 yes | yes | yes | yes
2851 Arguments :
2852 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2853 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2854
2855 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2856 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2857 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2858 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2859 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2860
2861 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2862 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2863 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2864
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002865 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2866
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002867 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2868 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2869 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2870 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002871 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002872
2873 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2874
2875
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002876email-alert from <emailaddr>
2877 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2878 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2880 yes | yes | yes | yes
2881
2882 Arguments :
2883
2884 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2885
2886 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2887 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2888
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002889 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2890 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2891
2892
2893email-alert level <level>
2894 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2895 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2896 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2897 yes | yes | yes | yes
2898
2899 Arguments :
2900
2901 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2902 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2903 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2904
2905 By default level is alert
2906
2907 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2908 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2909 for the proxy.
2910
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002911 Alerts are sent when :
2912
2913 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2914 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2915 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2916 is notice or lower
2917 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2918 and a health check status update occurs
2919
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002920 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2921 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002922 section 3.6 about mailers.
2923
2924
2925email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2926 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2928 yes | yes | yes | yes
2929
2930 Arguments :
2931
2932 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2933
2934 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2935 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2936
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002937 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2938 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002939
2940
2941email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2942 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2943 mailers.
2944 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2945 yes | yes | yes | yes
2946
2947 Arguments :
2948
2949 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2950
2951 By default the systems hostname is used.
2952
2953 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2954 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2955 for the proxy.
2956
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002957 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2958 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002959
2960
2961email-alert to <emailaddr>
2962 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2963 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2965 yes | yes | yes | yes
2966
2967 Arguments :
2968
2969 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2970
2971 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2972 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2973
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002974 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002975 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
2976
2977
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002978force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2979 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2980 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2981 no | yes | yes | yes
2982
2983 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2984 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2985 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2986 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2987 marked down for maintenance operations.
2988
2989 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2990 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2991 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2992 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2993 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2994 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2995 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2996 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2997 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2998
2999 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3000 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3001 is used.
3002
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003003 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003004 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003005
3006
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003007fullconn <conns>
3008 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3010 yes | no | yes | yes
3011 Arguments :
3012 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3013 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3014
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003015 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003016 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003017 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003018 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3019 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3020 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3021 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3022 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003023 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003024
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003025 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3026 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003027 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3028 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3029 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003030
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003031 Example :
3032 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3033 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3034 # connections.
3035 backend dynamic
3036 fullconn 10000
3037 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3038 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3039
3040 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3041
3042
3043grace <time>
3044 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003046 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003047 Arguments :
3048 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3049 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3050 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3051
3052 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3053 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003054 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003055 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3056
3057 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3058 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3059 simplify it.
3060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003061
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003062hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003063 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3065 yes | no | yes | yes
3066 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003067 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3068 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003069
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003070 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3071 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3072 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3073 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3074 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3075 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3076 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3077 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3078 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3079 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003080
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003081 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3082 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3083 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3084 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3085 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3086 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3087 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3088 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3089 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3090 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3091 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3092 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3093 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003094 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3095 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003096
3097 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3098
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003099 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003100 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3101 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3102 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003103 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3104 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3105 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003106
3107 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3108 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003109 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3110 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3111 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3112 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3113
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003114 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3115 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3116 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3117 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3118 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3119 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3120 parameter.
3121
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003122 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3123 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3124 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3125 used on strings.
3126
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003127 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3128
3129 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3130 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3131 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3132 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3133 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3134 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3135 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3136 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3137 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3138 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3139 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3140 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003141
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003142 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3143 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3144 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003145
3146 See also : "balance", "server"
3147
3148
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003149http-check disable-on-404
3150 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003152 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003153 Arguments : none
3154
3155 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3156 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3157 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3158 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3159 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3160 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3161 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3162 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003163 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3164 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3165 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3166
3167 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3168
3169
3170http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003171 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003173 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003174 Arguments :
3175 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3176 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003177 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003178 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3179 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3180 details on the supported keywords.
3181
3182 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3183 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3184 with the usual backslash ('\').
3185
3186 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3187 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3188 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3189 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3190 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3191
3192 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003193 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003194 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3195 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3196 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3197
3198 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003199 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003200 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3201 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3202 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3203 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3204
3205 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003206 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003207 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3208 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3209 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3210 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3211 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3212 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3213 trace).
3214
3215 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003216 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003217 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3218 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3219 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3220 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3221 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3222 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3223
3224 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3225 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3226 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3227 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3228 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3229 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3230 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3231 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3232
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003233 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3234 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3235 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3236
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003237 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3238 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3239
3240 Examples :
3241 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003242 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003243
3244 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003245 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003246
3247 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003248 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003249
3250 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003251 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003252
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003253 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003254
3255
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003256http-check send-state
3257 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3259 yes | no | yes | yes
3260 Arguments : none
3261
3262 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3263 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3264 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3265 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3266 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3267
3268 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3269 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3270 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3271 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3272 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003273 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3274 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3275 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3276
3277 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3278 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3279 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3280
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003281 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3282 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3283 checked in multiple backends.
3284
3285 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3286 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3287
3288 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3289 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3290 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3291 one fails.
3292
3293 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3294 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3295 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3296
3297 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3298 server's queue.
3299
3300 Example of a header received by the application server :
3301 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3302 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3303
3304 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3305
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003306http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003307 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003308 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003309 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003310 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3311 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003312 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3313 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003314 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3315 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3316 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003317 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003318 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3319 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003320 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003321 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003322 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3323
3324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3325 no | yes | yes | yes
3326
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003327 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3328 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3329 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3330 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3331 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003332
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003333 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3334 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3335 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3336
3337 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3338 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3339 are evaluated.
3340
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003341 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3342 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3343 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3344 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3345 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3346 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3347 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3348 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3349 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003350 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003351 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3352
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003353 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3354 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3355 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3356 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3357 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3358
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003359 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3360 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3361 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003362 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3363 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003364
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003365 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3366 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3367 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3368 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3369 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3370 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3371 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3372 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3373
3374 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3375 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3376 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003377 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3378 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003379
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003380 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3381 <name>.
3382
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003383 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3384 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3385 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3386 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3387 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3388 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3389 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3390 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3391
3392 Example:
3393
3394 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3395
3396 applied to:
3397
3398 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3399
3400 outputs:
3401
3402 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3403
3404 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3405
3406 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3407 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3408 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3409 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3410 header.
3411
3412 Example:
3413
3414 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3415
3416 applied to:
3417
3418 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3419
3420 outputs:
3421
3422 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3423
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003424 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3425 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3426 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3427 it.
3428
3429 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3430 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3431 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3432 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3433 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3434 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3435
3436 Example :
3437 # prepend the host name before the path
3438 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3439
3440 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3441 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3442 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3443 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3444 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3445 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3446 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3447 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3448
3449 Example :
3450 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3451 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3452
3453 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3454 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3455 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3456 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3457 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3458 "set-query".
3459
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003460 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3461 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3462 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3463 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3464 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3465 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3466 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3467 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3468
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003469 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3470 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3471 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3472 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3473 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3474 another equipment.
3475
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003476 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3477 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3478 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3479 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3480 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3481 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3482 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3483 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3484
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003485 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3486 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3487 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3488 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3489 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3490 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3491 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3492 admin privileges.
3493
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003494 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3495 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3496 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3497 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3498 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3499 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3500 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3501 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3502
3503 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3504 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3505 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3506 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3507 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3508 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3509
3510 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3511 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3512 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3513 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3514 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3515 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3516
3517 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3518 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3519 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3520 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3521 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3522 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3523 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3524 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3525 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3526
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003527 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003528 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3529 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3530 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3531 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3532 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3533 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3534 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3535 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3536 request header" for more information.
3537
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003538 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3539 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3540 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3541 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3542
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003543 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3544 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3545 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3546 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3547 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3548 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3549 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3550 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3551 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3552 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3553 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3554 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3555
3556 These actions take one or two arguments :
3557 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3558 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3559 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3560 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3561
3562 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3563 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3564 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3565 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3566
3567 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3568 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3569 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3570 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3571 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3572 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3573 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3574 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3575
3576 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3577 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3578 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3579 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3580 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3581
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003582 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3583 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3584 function is documented in the API documentation.
3585
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003586 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3587
3588 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3589 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3590 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3591 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003592
3593 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003594 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3595 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3596 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003597
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003598 http-request allow if nagios
3599 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3600 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3601 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003602
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003603 Example:
3604 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003605 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003606
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003607 Example:
3608 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3609 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3610 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3611 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3612 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3613 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3614 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3615 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3616 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3617
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003618 Example:
3619 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3620 acl add path /addacl
3621 acl del path /delacl
3622
3623 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3624
3625 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3626 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3627
3628 Example:
3629 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3630 acl setmap path /setmap
3631 acl delmap path /delmap
3632
3633 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3634
3635 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3636 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3637
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003638 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3639 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003640
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003641http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003642 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003643 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003644 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3645 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003646 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3647 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3648 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3649 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003650 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3651 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003652 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003653 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003654 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3655
3656 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 no | yes | yes | yes
3658
3659 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3660 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3661 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3662 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3663 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3664 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3665
3666 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3667 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3668 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3669 current section.
3670
3671 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3672 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3673 rules are evaluated.
3674
3675 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3676 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3677 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3678 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3679 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3680 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3681 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3682
3683 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3684 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3685 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3686 external users.
3687
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003688 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3689 <name>.
3690
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003691 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3692 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3693 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3694 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3695 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3696 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3697 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3698 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3699
3700 Example:
3701
3702 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3703
3704 applied to:
3705
3706 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3707
3708 outputs:
3709
3710 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3711
3712 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3713
3714 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3715 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3716 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3717 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3718 header.
3719
3720 Example:
3721
3722 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3723
3724 applied to:
3725
3726 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3727
3728 outputs:
3729
3730 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3731
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003732 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3733 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3734 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3735 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3736 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3737 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3738 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3739 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3740
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003741 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3742 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3743 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3744 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3745 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3746 another equipment.
3747
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003748 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3749 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3750 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3751 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3752 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3753 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3754 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3755 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3756
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003757 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3758 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3759 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3760 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3761 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3762 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3763 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3764 admin privileges.
3765
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003766 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3767 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3768 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3769 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3770 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3771 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3772 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3773 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3774
3775 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3776 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3777 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3778 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3779 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3780 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3781
3782 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3783 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3784 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3785 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3786 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3787 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3788
3789 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3790 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3791 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3792 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3793 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3794 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3795 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3796 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3797 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3798
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003799 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3800 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3801 function is documented in the API documentation.
3802
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003803 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3804 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3805 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3806 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3807 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3808 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
3809 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3810 response header" for more information.
3811
3812 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
3813 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
3814 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
3815 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
3816 keyword.
3817
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003818 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3819 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
3820 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
3821 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
3822 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
3823 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
3824
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003825 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3826
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003827 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003828 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3829 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3830 rules.
3831
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003832 Example:
3833 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3834
3835 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3836
3837 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3838 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3839
3840 Example:
3841 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3842
3843 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3844
3845 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3846 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3847
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003848 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3849 ACL usage.
3850
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003851
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003852http-send-name-header [<header>]
3853 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3854
3855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | no | yes | yes
3857
3858 Arguments :
3859
3860 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3861
3862 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3863 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3864 is added with the header string proved.
3865
3866 See also : "server"
3867
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003868id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003869 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3871 no | yes | yes | yes
3872 Arguments : none
3873
3874 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3875 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3876 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003877
3878
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003879ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3880 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3881 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3882 no | yes | yes | yes
3883
3884 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3885 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3886 and running).
3887
3888 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3889 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3890 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003891 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003892 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3893
3894 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3895 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3896
3897 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3898 "unless" condition is met.
3899
3900 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3901
3902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003903log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003904log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003905no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003906 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003909
3910 Prefix :
3911 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3912 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3913 prefix does not allow arguments.
3914
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003915 Arguments :
3916 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3917 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3918 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3919 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3920 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3921 parameter.
3922
3923 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3924 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3925
3926 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3927 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3928 standard syslog port).
3929
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003930 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3931 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3932 standard syslog port).
3933
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003934 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3935 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3936 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3937 appropriately writeable).
3938
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003939 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3940 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003941
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003942 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3943 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3944 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3945 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3946 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3947 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3948 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3949 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3950 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3951 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3952 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3953
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003954 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3955
3956 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3957 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3958 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3959
3960 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3961 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3962 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003963 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3964 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3965 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3966 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3967 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003968
3969 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3970
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003971 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3972 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3973 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003974
3975 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3976 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3977 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3978 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3979
3980 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3981 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003982
3983 Example :
3984 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003985 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3986 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003987 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003988
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003989
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003990log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003991 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3993 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003994
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003995 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3996 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3997 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3998 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3999 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004000
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004001log-tag <string>
4002 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4003 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4004 yes | yes | yes | yes
4005
4006 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4007 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4008 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4009 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4010 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4011 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4012 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4013 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4014 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004015
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004016max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4017 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4019 yes | no | yes | yes
4020
4021 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4022 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4023 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4024 servers.
4025
4026 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4027 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4028 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4029 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4030 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4031 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4032 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4033 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4034 picking a different server.
4035
4036 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4037 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4038 even if they have to be queued.
4039
4040 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4041 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4042
4043
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004044maxconn <conns>
4045 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4047 yes | yes | yes | no
4048 Arguments :
4049 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4050 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4051 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4052 closes.
4053
4054 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4055 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4056 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4057 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4058 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4059 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4060 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4061 properly tuned.
4062
4063 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4064 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4065 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4066
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004067 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4068
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004069 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4070
4071
4072mode { tcp|http|health }
4073 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4075 yes | yes | yes | yes
4076 Arguments :
4077 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4078 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4079 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4080 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4081
4082 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4083 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4084 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4085 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4086 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4087
4088 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004089 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4090 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4091 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4092 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4093 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4094 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4095 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004096
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004097 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4098 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4099 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004100
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004101 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004102 defaults http_instances
4103 mode http
4104
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004105 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004106
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004107
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004108monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004109 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4111 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004112 Arguments :
4113 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4114 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004115 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004116 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4117 backend and its backup.
4118
4119 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4120 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4121 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4122 servers in a list of backends.
4123
4124 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4125 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4126 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4127 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4128 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4129 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4130 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004131 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4132 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004133
4134 Example:
4135 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004136 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004137 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4138 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4139 monitor-uri /site_alive
4140 monitor fail if site_dead
4141
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004142 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004143
4144
4145monitor-net <source>
4146 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4148 yes | yes | yes | no
4149 Arguments :
4150 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4151 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4152 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4153 followed by a mask.
4154
4155 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4156 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004157 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004158 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4159
4160 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4161 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4162 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4163 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004164 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4165 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4166 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004167
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004168 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4169 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4170 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4171 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4172 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4173 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004174
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004175 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4176 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004177
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004178 Example :
4179 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4180 frontend www
4181 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4182
4183 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4184
4185
4186monitor-uri <uri>
4187 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4189 yes | yes | yes | no
4190 Arguments :
4191 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4192 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4193
4194 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4195 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4196 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4197 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4198 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4199 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4200 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4201 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4202
4203 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4204 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4205 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4206 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4207 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4208 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4209
4210 Example :
4211 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4212 frontend www
4213 mode http
4214 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4215
4216 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004218
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004219option abortonclose
4220no option abortonclose
4221 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4223 yes | no | yes | yes
4224 Arguments : none
4225
4226 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4227 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4228 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4229 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004230 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004231 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4232 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4233 encountered while delivering the response.
4234
4235 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4236 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4237 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4238 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4239 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4240 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004241 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004242 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004243 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004244 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4245 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4246 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4247
4248 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4249 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4250 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4251 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4252 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4253 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4254 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4255 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004256 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004257
4258 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4259 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4260
4261 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4262
4263
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004264option accept-invalid-http-request
4265no option accept-invalid-http-request
4266 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 yes | yes | yes | no
4269 Arguments : none
4270
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004271 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004272 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4273 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4274 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4275 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4276 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4277 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4278 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004279 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4280 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4281 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4282 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4283 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004284 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004285 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4286 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4287 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004288
4289 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4290 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4291 been confirmed.
4292
4293 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4294 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004295 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4296 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004297 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4298
4299 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4300 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4301
4302 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4303 stats socket.
4304
4305
4306option accept-invalid-http-response
4307no option accept-invalid-http-response
4308 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4310 yes | no | yes | yes
4311 Arguments : none
4312
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004313 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004314 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4315 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4316 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4317 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4318 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4319 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4320 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004321 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4322 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4323 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004324
4325 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4326 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4327 been confirmed.
4328
4329 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4330 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4331 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4332 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4333
4334 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4335 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4336
4337 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4338 stats socket.
4339
4340
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004341option allbackups
4342no option allbackups
4343 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4345 yes | no | yes | yes
4346 Arguments : none
4347
4348 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4349 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4350 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4351 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4352 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4353 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4354 order between the backup servers anymore.
4355
4356 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4357 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4358
4359 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4360 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4361
4362
4363option checkcache
4364no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004365 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4367 yes | no | yes | yes
4368 Arguments : none
4369
4370 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4371 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004372 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004373 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4374 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004375 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004376
4377 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004378 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004379 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004380 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4381 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004382 to the client are :
4383 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004384 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004385 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004386 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4387 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4388 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4389 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4390 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4391 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4392 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4393 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4394 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4395 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4396 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4397
4398 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004399 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004400 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004401 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004402 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4403
4404 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4405 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004406 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004407 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4408
4409 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4410 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4411
4412
4413option clitcpka
4414no option clitcpka
4415 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4417 yes | yes | yes | no
4418 Arguments : none
4419
4420 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4421 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4422 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4423 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4424
4425 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4426 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4427 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4428 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4429
4430 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4431 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4432 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4433 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4434 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4435
4436 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4437
4438 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4439 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4440 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4441
4442 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4443 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4444
4445 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4446
4447
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004448option contstats
4449 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4451 yes | yes | yes | no
4452 Arguments : none
4453
4454 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4455 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4456 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4457 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4458 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4459 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4460 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4461
4462
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004463option dontlog-normal
4464no option dontlog-normal
4465 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4467 yes | yes | yes | no
4468 Arguments : none
4469
4470 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4471 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4472 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4473 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4474 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4475 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4476 logged.
4477
4478 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4479 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4480 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004482 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004483 logging.
4484
4485
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004486option dontlognull
4487no option dontlognull
4488 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4490 yes | yes | yes | no
4491 Arguments : none
4492
4493 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4494 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4495 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4496 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4497 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4498 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004499 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4500 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4501 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004502
4503 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4504 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4505 would not be logged.
4506
4507 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4508 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4509
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004510 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4511 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004512
4513
4514option forceclose
4515no option forceclose
4516 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004518 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004519 Arguments : none
4520
4521 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4522 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4523 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4524 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4525 global session times in the logs.
4526
4527 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004528 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004529 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004530
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004531 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4532 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4533 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4534
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004535 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4536 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004537
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004538 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4539 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4540
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004541 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004542
4543
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004544option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004545 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4547 yes | yes | yes | yes
4548 Arguments :
4549 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4550 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004551 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004552 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004553
4554 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4555 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4556 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4557 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4558 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4559 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4560 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004561 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4562 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4563 possible that the client has already brought one.
4564
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004565 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004566 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004567 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4568 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004569 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4570 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004571
4572 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4573 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4574 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4575 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4576 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4577 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4578 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4579
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004580 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4581 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4582 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4583 are under the control of the end-user.
4584
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004585 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004586 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4587 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004588 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4589 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4590 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004591
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004592 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004593 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4594 frontend www
4595 mode http
4596 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4597
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004598 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4599 backend www
4600 mode http
4601 option forwardfor header X-Client
4602
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004603 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004604 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004605
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004606
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004607option http-buffer-request
4608no option http-buffer-request
4609 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4611 yes | yes | yes | yes
4612 Arguments : none
4613
4614 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4615 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4616 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4617 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4618 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4619 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4620 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4621 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4622 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4623 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4624 default.
4625
4626 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4627
4628
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004629option http-ignore-probes
4630no option http-ignore-probes
4631 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4633 yes | yes | yes | no
4634 Arguments : none
4635
4636 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4637 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4638 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4639 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4640 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4641 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4642 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4643 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4644 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4645 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4646 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4647 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4648
4649 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4650 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4651 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4652 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4653 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4654 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4655 are often the only way to detect them.
4656
4657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4659
4660 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4661
4662
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004663option http-keep-alive
4664no option http-keep-alive
4665 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4667 yes | yes | yes | yes
4668 Arguments : none
4669
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004670 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4671 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4672 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4673 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4674 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4675 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4676 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4677
4678 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4679 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004680 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4681 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4682 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4683 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4684 situations where this option may be useful :
4685
4686 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4687 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4688
4689 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4690 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4691
4692 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4693 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4694 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4695 request.
4696
4697 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4698 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004699 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4700 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4701 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004702
4703 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4704 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4705
4706 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4707 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4708 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4709 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4710 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4711 not set.
4712
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004713 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4714 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004715 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004716 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004717
4718 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004719 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4720 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004721
4722
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004723option http-no-delay
4724no option http-no-delay
4725 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4727 yes | yes | yes | yes
4728 Arguments : none
4729
4730 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4731 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4732 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4733 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4734 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4735 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4736 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4737 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4738 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4739 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4740 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4741 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4742 affected.
4743
4744 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4745 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4746 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4747 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4748 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4749 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4750 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4751 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4752 latency environments.
4753
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004754 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
4755
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004756
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004757option http-pretend-keepalive
4758no option http-pretend-keepalive
4759 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 yes | yes | yes | yes
4762 Arguments : none
4763
4764 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4765 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4766 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4767 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4768 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4769 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4770 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4771 consider the response complete.
4772
4773 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4774 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4775 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4776 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4777 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4778 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4779
4780 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4781 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4782 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4783 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4784 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4785 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4786 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4787
4788 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4789 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004790 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004791 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4792 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004793
4794 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4795 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4796
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004797 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4798 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004799
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004800
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004801option http-server-close
4802no option http-server-close
4803 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4805 yes | yes | yes | yes
4806 Arguments : none
4807
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004808 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4809 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4810 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4811 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4812 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4813 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4814 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4815 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4816 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4817 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4818 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4819 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4820 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4821 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4822 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4823 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004824
4825 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4826 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4827 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4828 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004829 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4830 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004831
4832 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4833 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004834 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4835 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004836 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4837 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004838
4839 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4840 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4841
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004842 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004843 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4844 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004845
4846
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004847option http-tunnel
4848no option http-tunnel
4849 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4851 yes | yes | yes | yes
4852 Arguments : none
4853
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004854 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4855 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4856 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4857 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4858 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4859 "option http-tunnel".
4860
4861 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004862 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004863 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4864 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4865 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4866 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4867 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4868 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4869 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004870
4871 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4872 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4873
4874 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4875 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4876 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4877
4878
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004879option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004880no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004881 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4883 yes | yes | yes | no
4884 Arguments : none
4885
4886 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4887 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4888 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4889 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4890 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4891 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4892 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4893
4894 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4895 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4896 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4897 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4898 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4899 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4900 request along its whole life.
4901
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004902 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4903 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4904 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4905 front of an existing proxy.
4906
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004907 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4908
4909 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4910 http-server-close".
4911
4912
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004913option httpchk
4914option httpchk <uri>
4915option httpchk <method> <uri>
4916option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4917 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4919 yes | no | yes | yes
4920 Arguments :
4921 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4922 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4923 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4924 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4925 ones.
4926
4927 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4928 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4929 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4930
4931 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4932 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4933 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4934 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4935 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4936
4937 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4938 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4939 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4940 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4941 the lack of any response.
4942
4943 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4944
4945 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4946 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4947 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4948
4949 Examples :
4950 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4951 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4952 backend https_relay
4953 mode tcp
4954 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4955 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4956
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004957 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4958 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4959 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004960
4961
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004962option httpclose
4963no option httpclose
4964 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4966 yes | yes | yes | yes
4967 Arguments : none
4968
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004969 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4970 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4971 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4972 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004973 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004974 "option http-tunnel".
4975
4976 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4977 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4978 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4979 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4980 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4981 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4982 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4983 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004984
4985 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004986 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004987 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4988 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4989 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4990 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4991 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004992
4993 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4994 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004995 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4996 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004997 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4998 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004999
5000 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5001 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5002
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005003 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5004 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005005
5006
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005007option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005008 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5010 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005011 Arguments :
5012 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5013 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5014 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5015 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5016 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005017
5018 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5019 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5020 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5021 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5022 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5023 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5024 ports.
5025
5026 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5027
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005028 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5029 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005031 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005032
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005033
5034option http_proxy
5035no option http_proxy
5036 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5038 yes | yes | yes | yes
5039 Arguments : none
5040
5041 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5042 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5043 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5044 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5045 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5046
5047 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5048 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5049 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5050 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005051 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005052 be analyzed.
5053
5054 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5055 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5056
5057 Example :
5058 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5059 backend direct_forward
5060 option httpclose
5061 option http_proxy
5062
5063 See also : "option httpclose"
5064
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005065
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005066option independent-streams
5067no option independent-streams
5068 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5070 yes | yes | yes | yes
5071 Arguments : none
5072
5073 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5074 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5075 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5076 receive data or not.
5077
5078 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5079 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5080 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5081 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5082 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5083 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5084 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5085 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5086 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5087 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5088 socket buffers.
5089
5090 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5091 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5092 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5093 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5094 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5095
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005096 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005097 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5098 deprecated.
5099
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005100 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005101
5102
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005103option ldap-check
5104 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5106 yes | no | yes | yes
5107 Arguments : none
5108
5109 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5110 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5111 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5112 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5113
5114 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5115 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5116
5117 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5118 configure it.
5119
5120 Example :
5121 option ldap-check
5122
5123 See also : "option httpchk"
5124
5125
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005126option external-check
5127 Use external processes for server health checks
5128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5129 yes | no | yes | yes
5130
5131 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5132 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5133 command".
5134
5135 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5136
5137 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5138
5139
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005140option log-health-checks
5141no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005142 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5144 yes | no | yes | yes
5145 Arguments : none
5146
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005147 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5148 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5149 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005150
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005151 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5152 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5153 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5154 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5155 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5156
5157 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5158 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005159
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005160 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5161 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5162 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005163
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005164
5165option log-separate-errors
5166no option log-separate-errors
5167 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5169 yes | yes | yes | no
5170 Arguments : none
5171
5172 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5173 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5174 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5175 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5176 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5177 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5178 provides very important information.
5179
5180 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5181 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5182 error logs.
5183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005184 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005185 logging.
5186
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005187
5188option logasap
5189no option logasap
5190 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5192 yes | yes | yes | no
5193 Arguments : none
5194
5195 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5196 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5197 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5198 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5199 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5200 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5201 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005202 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005203 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5204 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5205
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005206 Examples :
5207 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5208 mode http
5209 option httplog
5210 option logasap
5211 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5212
5213 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5214 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5215 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5216 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005218 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005219 logging.
5220
5221
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005222option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005223 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5225 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005226 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005227 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5228 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005229 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005230
5231 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5232 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5233 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5234 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5235 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5236 in the MySQL table, like this :
5237
5238 USE mysql;
5239 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5240 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5241
5242 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5243 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5244 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5245 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5246 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5247 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5248 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5249 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5250 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5251
5252 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5253 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005254
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005255 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005256
5257 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5258 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5259 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5260 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5261 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5262 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5263
5264 See also: "option httpchk"
5265
5266
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005267option nolinger
5268no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005269 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5271 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005272 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005273
5274 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5275 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5276 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5277 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5278 connections.
5279
5280 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5281 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5282 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5283 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5284 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5285 this too.
5286
5287 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5288 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5289 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5290
5291 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5292 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5293 for servers.
5294
5295 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5296 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5297
5298
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005299option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5300 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5302 yes | yes | yes | yes
5303 Arguments :
5304 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5305 matching <network>
5306 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5307 header name.
5308
5309 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5310 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5311 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5312 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5313 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5314 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5315 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5316 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5317 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5318 possible that the client has already brought one.
5319
5320 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5321 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5322 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5323 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5324 header and requires different one.
5325
5326 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5327 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5328 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5329 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5330 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5331 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5332 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5333
5334 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5335 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5336 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5337 both are defined.
5338
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005339 Examples :
5340 # Original Destination address
5341 frontend www
5342 mode http
5343 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5344
5345 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5346 backend www
5347 mode http
5348 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5349
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005350 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5351 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005352
5353
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005354option persist
5355no option persist
5356 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5357 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5358 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005359 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005360
5361 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5362 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5363 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5364 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5365 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5366 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5367 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5368 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5369 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5370 redirected to another valid server.
5371
5372 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5373 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5374
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005375 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005376
5377
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005378option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5379 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5381 yes | no | yes | yes
5382 Arguments :
5383 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5384 PostgreSQL server.
5385
5386 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5387 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5388 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5389 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5390
5391 See also: "option httpchk"
5392
5393
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005394option prefer-last-server
5395no option prefer-last-server
5396 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5397 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5398 yes | no | yes | yes
5399 Arguments : none
5400
5401 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5402 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5403 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5404 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5405 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5406 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5407 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5408 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5409 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005410 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5411 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5412 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5413 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5414 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5415 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5416 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005417
5418 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5419 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5420
5421 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5422
5423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005424option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005425option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005426no option redispatch
5427 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5429 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005430 Arguments :
5431 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5432 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5433 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5434 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5435 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5436 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5437 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5438 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5439 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5440
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005441
5442 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5443 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5444 be able to access the service anymore.
5445
5446 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5447 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5448
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005449 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005450 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5451 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005453 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5454 "redisp" keywords.
5455
5456 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5457 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5458
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005459 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005460
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005461
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005462option redis-check
5463 Use redis health checks for server testing
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 yes | no | yes | yes
5466 Arguments : none
5467
5468 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5469 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5470 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5471 find the "+PONG" response message.
5472
5473 Example :
5474 option redis-check
5475
5476 See also : "option httpchk"
5477
5478
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005479option smtpchk
5480option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5481 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5483 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005484 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005485 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5486 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5487 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5488
5489 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5490 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5491 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5492
5493 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5494 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5495 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5496 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5497 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5498 dead server.
5499
5500 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5501 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5502 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5503 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5504
5505 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5506 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5507 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5508 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5509 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5510
5511 Example :
5512 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5513
5514 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005517option socket-stats
5518no option socket-stats
5519
5520 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5522 yes | yes | yes | no
5523
5524 Arguments : none
5525
5526
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005527option splice-auto
5528no option splice-auto
5529 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5531 yes | yes | yes | yes
5532 Arguments : none
5533
5534 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5535 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5536 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5537 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005538 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005539 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5540 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5541 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5542 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5543
5544 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5545 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5546 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5547 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5548 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5549 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5550 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5551 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5552 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5553 keyword.
5554
5555 Example :
5556 option splice-auto
5557
5558 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5559 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5560
5561 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5562 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5563
5564
5565option splice-request
5566no option splice-request
5567 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5569 yes | yes | yes | yes
5570 Arguments : none
5571
5572 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005573 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005574 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5575 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5576 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5577 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5578
5579 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5580
5581 Example :
5582 option splice-request
5583
5584 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5585 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5586
5587 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5588 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5589
5590
5591option splice-response
5592no option splice-response
5593 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5595 yes | yes | yes | yes
5596 Arguments : none
5597
5598 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005599 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005600 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5601 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5602 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5603 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5604
5605 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5606
5607 Example :
5608 option splice-response
5609
5610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5612
5613 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5614 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5615
5616
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005617option srvtcpka
5618no option srvtcpka
5619 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5621 yes | no | yes | yes
5622 Arguments : none
5623
5624 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5625 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5626 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5627 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5628
5629 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5630 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5631 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5632 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5633
5634 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5635 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5636 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5637 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5638 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5639
5640 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5641
5642 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5643 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5644 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5645
5646 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5647 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5648
5649 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5650
5651
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005652option ssl-hello-chk
5653 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5655 yes | no | yes | yes
5656 Arguments : none
5657
5658 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5659 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5660 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5661 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5662 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5663 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5664 hello message.
5665
5666 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5667 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5668 messages, which is appreciable.
5669
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005670 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5671 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5672 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005673
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005674 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5675
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005676
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005677option tcp-check
5678 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5679 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5680 yes | no | yes | yes
5681
5682 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5683 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5684
5685 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5686 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5687 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5688
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005689 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005690 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5691 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5692 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5693 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5694 only.
5695
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005696 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005697 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5698 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5699 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5700 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5701
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005702 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005703 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5704 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005705 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005706 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5707 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5708 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5709 the respective protocols.
5710 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5711 analysed.
5712
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005713 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
5714 script.
5715
5716 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
5717 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
5718 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
5719 The "comment" is of course optional.
5720
5721
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005722 Examples :
5723 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5724 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005725 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005726
5727 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5728 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005729 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005730
5731 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5732 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005733 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005734 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005735 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005736 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005737 tcp-check expect +PONGe
5738 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005739 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5740 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005741 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005742 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5743 tcp-check expect string +OK
5744
5745 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5746 (send many headers before analyzing)
5747 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005748 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005749 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5750 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5751 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5752 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005753 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005754
5755
5756 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5757
5758
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005759option tcp-smart-accept
5760no option tcp-smart-accept
5761 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5763 yes | yes | yes | no
5764 Arguments : none
5765
5766 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5767 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5768 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5769 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5770 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5771 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5772
5773 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5774 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5775 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5776 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5777
5778 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5779 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5780 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5781 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5782
5783 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5784 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5785 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5786
5787 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5788 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5789 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5790
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005791 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5792
5793
5794option tcp-smart-connect
5795no option tcp-smart-connect
5796 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5798 yes | no | yes | yes
5799 Arguments : none
5800
5801 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5802 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5803 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5804 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5805 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5806
5807 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5808 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5809 complex.
5810
5811 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5812 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5813 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5814
5815 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5816 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5817
5818 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5819
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005820
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005821option tcpka
5822 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5824 yes | yes | yes | yes
5825 Arguments : none
5826
5827 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5828 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5829 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5830 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5831
5832 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5833 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5834 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5835 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5836
5837 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5838 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5839 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5840 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5841 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5842
5843 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5844
5845 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5846 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5847 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5848 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5849 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5850 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5851 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5852 backends.
5853
5854 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5855
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005856
5857option tcplog
5858 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5860 yes | yes | yes | yes
5861 Arguments : none
5862
5863 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5864 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5865 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5866 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5867 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5868 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5869 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5870 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5871
5872 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005874 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005875
5876
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005877option transparent
5878no option transparent
5879 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005881 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005882 Arguments : none
5883
5884 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5885 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5886 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5887 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5888 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5889 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5890 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5891 appropriate server.
5892
5893 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5894 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5895
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005896 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005897 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005898
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005899
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005900external-check command <command>
5901 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5903 yes | no | yes | yes
5904
5905 Arguments :
5906 <command> is the external command to run
5907
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005908 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5909
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005910 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005911
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005912 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5913 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5914 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5915 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5916 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5917 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005918
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005919 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5920
5921 Environment variables :
5922 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5923 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5924
5925 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5926
5927 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5928
5929 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5930 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5931 for a UNIX socket).
5932
5933 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5934
5935 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5936
5937 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5938
5939 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5940
5941 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5942
5943 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5944 socket).
5945
5946 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5947 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5948
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005949 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5950 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5951 failed.
5952
5953 Example :
5954 external-check command /bin/true
5955
5956 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5957
5958
5959external-check path <path>
5960 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5962 yes | no | yes | yes
5963
5964 Arguments :
5965 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5966
5967 The default path is "".
5968
5969 Example :
5970 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5971
5972 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5973 "external-check command"
5974
5975
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005976persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005977persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005978 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5980 yes | no | yes | yes
5981 Arguments :
5982 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005983 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5984 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005985
5986 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5987 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5988 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5989 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5990 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5991 forwarded to this server.
5992
5993 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5994 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5995 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005996 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005997 a single "listen" section.
5998
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005999 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6000 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6001 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6002
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006003 Example :
6004 listen tse-farm
6005 bind :3389
6006 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6007 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6008 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6009 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6010 persist rdp-cookie
6011 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006012 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006013 balance rdp-cookie
6014 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6015 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6016
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006017 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6018 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006019
6020
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006021rate-limit sessions <rate>
6022 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6024 yes | yes | yes | no
6025 Arguments :
6026 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6027 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6028
6029 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6030 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6031 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6032 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6033 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6034 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6035
6036 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6037 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6038 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6039 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6040
6041 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6042 listen smtp
6043 mode tcp
6044 bind :25
6045 rate-limit sessions 10
6046 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6047
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006048 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6049 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6050 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006051
6052 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6053
6054
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006055redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6056redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6057redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006058 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6060 no | yes | yes | yes
6061
6062 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006063 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006064
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006065 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006066 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006067 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6068 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6069 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006070
6071 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6072 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6073 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6074 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6075 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006076 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6077 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6078 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6079 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006080
6081 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6082 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6083 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6084 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6085 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6086 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006087 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006088 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006089 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6090 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6091 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006092
6093 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006094 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6095 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6096 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
6097 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
6098 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6099 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6100 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6101 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006102
6103 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6104 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6105
6106 - "drop-query"
6107 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6108 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6109 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6110 with a location-type redirect.
6111
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006112 - "append-slash"
6113 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6114 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6115 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6116 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6117
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006118 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6119 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6120 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6121 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6122 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6123 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6124 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6125
6126 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6127 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6128 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6129 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6130 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6131 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6132 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006133
6134 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6135 acl clear dst_port 80
6136 acl secure dst_port 8080
6137 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006138 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006139 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006140 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6141
6142 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006143 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6144 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6145 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006146 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006147
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006148 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6149 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6150 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6151
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006152 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006153 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006154
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006155 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6156 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6157 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006159 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006160
6161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006162redisp (deprecated)
6163redispatch (deprecated)
6164 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6166 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006167 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006168
6169 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6170 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6171 be able to access the service anymore.
6172
6173 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6174 redistribute them to a working server.
6175
6176 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6177 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6178 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006179
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006180 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6181 "option redispatch" instead.
6182
6183 See also : "option redispatch"
6184
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006185
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006186reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006187 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6189 no | yes | yes | yes
6190 Arguments :
6191 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6192 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006193 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006194
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006195 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6196 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6197
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006198 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6199 the last header of an HTTP request.
6200
6201 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6202 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6203 responses.
6204
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006205 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6206 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6207 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6208
6209 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6210 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006211
6212
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006213reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6214reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006215 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6217 no | yes | yes | yes
6218 Arguments :
6219 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6220 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6221 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6222 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6223 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6224 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6225 ignores case.
6226
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006227 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6228 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6229
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006230 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6231 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6232 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6233 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006234 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006235
6236 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6237 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6238
6239 Example :
6240 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6241 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6242 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6243
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006244 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6245 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006246
6247
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006248reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6249reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006250 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 no | yes | yes | yes
6253 Arguments :
6254 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6255 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6256 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6257 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6258 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6259 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6260
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006261 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6262 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6263
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006264 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6265 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6266 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6267 next servers.
6268
6269 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6270 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6271 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6272
6273 Example :
6274 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6275 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6276 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6277
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006278 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6279 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006280
6281
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006282reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6283reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006284 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6286 no | yes | yes | yes
6287 Arguments :
6288 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6289 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6290 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6291 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6292 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6293 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6294 case.
6295
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006296 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6297 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6298
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006299 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6300 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6301 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6302 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006303 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006304
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006305 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006306 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006307 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006308
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006309 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6310 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6311
6312 Example :
6313 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6314 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6315 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6316
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006317 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6318 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006319
6320
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006321reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6322reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006323 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6325 no | yes | yes | yes
6326 Arguments :
6327 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6328 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6329 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6330 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6331 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6332 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6333 case.
6334
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006335 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6336 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6337
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006338 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6339 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6340 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6341 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6342
6343 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6344 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6345
6346 Example :
6347 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6348 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6349 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6350 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6351
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006352 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6353 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006354
6355
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006356reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6357reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006358 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6360 no | yes | yes | yes
6361 Arguments :
6362 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6363 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6364 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6365 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6366 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6367 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6368
6369 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6370 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6371 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6372 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006373 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006374
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006375 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6376 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6377
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006378 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6379 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6380 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6381
6382 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6383 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6384 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6385 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6386 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6387
6388 Example :
6389 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006390 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006391 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6392 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6393
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006394 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6395 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006396
6397
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006398reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6399reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006400 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6402 no | yes | yes | yes
6403 Arguments :
6404 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6405 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6406 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6407 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6408 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6409 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6410 ignores case.
6411
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006412 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6413 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6414
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006415 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6416 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006417 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6418 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6419 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006420 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6421 not set.
6422
6423 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6424 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6425 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6426 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6427 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6428
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006429 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006430 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6431 # block all others.
6432 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6433 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6434
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006435 # block bad guys
6436 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6437 reqitarpit . if badguys
6438
6439 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6440 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006441
6442
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006443retries <value>
6444 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6445 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6446 yes | no | yes | yes
6447 Arguments :
6448 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6449 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6450 default value is 3.
6451
6452 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6453 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6454 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6455
6456 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006457 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6458 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006459
6460 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6461 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6462
6463 See also : "option redispatch"
6464
6465
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006466rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006467 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6469 no | yes | yes | yes
6470 Arguments :
6471 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6472 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006473 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006474
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006475 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6476 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6477
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006478 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6479 the last header of an HTTP response.
6480
6481 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6482 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6483 responses.
6484
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006485 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6486 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006487
6488
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006489rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6490rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006491 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6493 no | yes | yes | yes
6494 Arguments :
6495 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6496 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6497 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6498 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6499 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6500 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6501 ignores case.
6502
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006503 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6504 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6505
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006506 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6507 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006508 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006509 client.
6510
6511 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6512 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6513 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6514
6515 Example :
6516 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006517 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006518
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006519 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6520 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006521
6522
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006523rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6524rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006525 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6527 no | yes | yes | yes
6528 Arguments :
6529 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6530 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6531 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6532 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6533 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6534 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6535 ignores case.
6536
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006537 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6538 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6539
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006540 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6541 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6542 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6543 case-sensitive.
6544
6545 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006546 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6547 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6548 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006549
6550 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6551 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6552
6553 Example :
6554 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6555 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6556
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006557 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6558 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006559
6560
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006561rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6562rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006563 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6565 no | yes | yes | yes
6566 Arguments :
6567 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6568 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6569 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6570 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6571 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6572 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6573 ignores case.
6574
6575 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6576 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6577 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6578 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006579 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006580
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006581 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6582 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6583
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006584 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6585 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6586 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6587
6588 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6589 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6590 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6591 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6592 are not case-sensitive.
6593
6594 Example :
6595 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6596 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6597
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006598 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6599 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006600
6601
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006602server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006603 Declare a server in a backend
6604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6605 no | no | yes | yes
6606 Arguments :
6607 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006608 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006609 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006610
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006611 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6612 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6613 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6614 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006615 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6616 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6617 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6618 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6619 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006620 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6621 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6622 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6623 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6624 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6625 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6626 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006627 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006628 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6629 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
6630 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006631
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006632 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006633 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6634 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6635 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6636 adding this value to the client's port.
6637
6638 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6639 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006640 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006641
6642 Examples :
6643 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6644 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006645 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006646 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
6647 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
6648 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006649
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006650 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6651 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006652
6653
6654source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006655source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006656source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006657 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6659 yes | no | yes | yes
6660 Arguments :
6661 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6662 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006663
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006664 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006665 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6666 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6667 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6668 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6669 supported prefixes are :
6670 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6671 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6672 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006673 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006674 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
6675 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006676
6677 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6678 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006679 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6680 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6681 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006682
6683 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6684 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6685 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6686 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6687 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6688 <addr>.
6689
6690 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6691 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6692 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6693 port.
6694
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006695 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6696 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6697 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6698 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006699 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006700 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6701 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6702 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6703 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6704 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6705 HTTP header.
6706
6707 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6708 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006709 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006710 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6711 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6712 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6713 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6714 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6715 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6716 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6717
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006718 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6719 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6720 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6721 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6722 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6723 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6724
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006725 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6726 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6727 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6728 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6729
6730 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6731 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6732 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6733 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6734 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6735 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6736
6737 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6738 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6739 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6740 there are two methods :
6741
6742 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6743 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6744 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6745 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6746 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6747 of the client ranges may be used.
6748
6749 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6750 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6751 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6752 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6753 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6754 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6755 same session.
6756
6757 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6758 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6759 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6760 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6761 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6762 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6763
6764 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6765 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6766 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006767 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006768
6769 Examples :
6770 backend private
6771 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6772 source 192.168.1.200
6773
6774 backend transparent_ssl1
6775 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6776 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6777
6778 backend transparent_ssl2
6779 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6780 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6781 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6782
6783 backend transparent_ssl3
6784 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6785 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6786 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6787
6788 backend transparent_smtp
6789 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6790 # with Tproxy version 4.
6791 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6792
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006793 backend transparent_http
6794 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6795 # proxy.
6796 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006798 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006799 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006801
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006802srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6803 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6805 yes | no | yes | yes
6806 Arguments :
6807 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6808 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6809 as explained at the top of this document.
6810
6811 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6812 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6813 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6814 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6815 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6816 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6817 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6818
6819 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6820 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6821 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6822 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6823 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006824 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006825 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006826 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006827
6828 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6829 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6830 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6831 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6832 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6833 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6834
6835 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6836 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6837
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006838 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6839 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006840
6841
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006842stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6843 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006845 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006846
6847 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6848 matched.
6849
6850 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6851 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6852
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006853 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6854 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6855 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6856
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006857 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6858 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6859 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6860 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006861
6862 Example :
6863 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6864 backend stats_localhost
6865 stats enable
6866 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6867
6868 Example :
6869 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6870 backend stats_auth
6871 stats enable
6872 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6873 stats admin if TRUE
6874
6875 Example :
6876 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6877 userlist stats-auth
6878 group admin users admin
6879 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6880 group readonly users haproxy
6881 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6882
6883 backend stats_auth
6884 stats enable
6885 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6886 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6887 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6888 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6889
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006890 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6891 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6892 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006893
6894
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006895stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6896 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006898 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006899 Arguments :
6900 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6901
6902 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6903
6904 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6905 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6906 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6907 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6908 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6909 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6910
6911 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6912 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6913 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006914 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006915
6916 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6917 report using "stats scope".
6918
6919 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6920 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6921 unobvious parameters.
6922
6923 Example :
6924 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6925 backend public_www
6926 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6927 stats enable
6928 stats hide-version
6929 stats scope .
6930 stats uri /admin?stats
6931 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6932 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6933 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6934
6935 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6936 backend private_monitoring
6937 stats enable
6938 stats uri /admin?stats
6939 stats refresh 5s
6940
6941 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6942
6943
6944stats enable
6945 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006947 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006948 Arguments : none
6949
6950 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6951 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6952 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6953 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6954 - stats auth : no authentication
6955 - stats scope : no restriction
6956
6957 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6958 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6959 unobvious parameters.
6960
6961 Example :
6962 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6963 backend public_www
6964 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6965 stats enable
6966 stats hide-version
6967 stats scope .
6968 stats uri /admin?stats
6969 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6970 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6971 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6972
6973 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6974 backend private_monitoring
6975 stats enable
6976 stats uri /admin?stats
6977 stats refresh 5s
6978
6979 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6980
6981
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006982stats hide-version
6983 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006985 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006986 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006987
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006988 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6989 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6990 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6991 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6992 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6993 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006995 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6996 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6997 unobvious parameters.
6998
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006999 Example :
7000 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7001 backend public_www
7002 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007003 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007004 stats hide-version
7005 stats scope .
7006 stats uri /admin?stats
7007 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7008 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7009 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007010
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007011 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7012 backend private_monitoring
7013 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007014 stats uri /admin?stats
7015 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007016
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007017 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007018
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007019
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007020stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7021 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7022 Access control for statistics
7023
7024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7025 no | no | yes | yes
7026
7027 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7028 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7029 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7030 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7031 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7032 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7033
7034 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7035 instance.
7036
7037 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7038 about ACL usage.
7039
7040
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007041stats realm <realm>
7042 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007044 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007045 Arguments :
7046 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7047 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7048 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7049
7050 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7051 using a backslash ('\').
7052
7053 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7054 only related to authentication.
7055
7056 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7057 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7058 unobvious parameters.
7059
7060 Example :
7061 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7062 backend public_www
7063 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7064 stats enable
7065 stats hide-version
7066 stats scope .
7067 stats uri /admin?stats
7068 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7069 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7070 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7071
7072 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7073 backend private_monitoring
7074 stats enable
7075 stats uri /admin?stats
7076 stats refresh 5s
7077
7078 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7079
7080
7081stats refresh <delay>
7082 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007084 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007085 Arguments :
7086 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7087 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7088 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7089 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7090 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7091 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7092
7093 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7094 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7095 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7096 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7097
7098 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7099 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7100 unobvious parameters.
7101
7102 Example :
7103 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7104 backend public_www
7105 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7106 stats enable
7107 stats hide-version
7108 stats scope .
7109 stats uri /admin?stats
7110 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7111 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7112 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7113
7114 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7115 backend private_monitoring
7116 stats enable
7117 stats uri /admin?stats
7118 stats refresh 5s
7119
7120 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7121
7122
7123stats scope { <name> | "." }
7124 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007126 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007127 Arguments :
7128 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7129 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7130 section in which the statement appears.
7131
7132 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7133 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7134 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7135 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7136 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7137 exists.
7138
7139 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7140 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7141 unobvious parameters.
7142
7143 Example :
7144 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7145 backend public_www
7146 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7147 stats enable
7148 stats hide-version
7149 stats scope .
7150 stats uri /admin?stats
7151 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7152 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7153 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7154
7155 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7156 backend private_monitoring
7157 stats enable
7158 stats uri /admin?stats
7159 stats refresh 5s
7160
7161 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7162
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007163
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007164stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007165 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007167 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007168
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007169 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007170 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7171
7172 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7173 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7174
7175 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7176 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007177 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007178
7179 Example :
7180 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7181 backend private_monitoring
7182 stats enable
7183 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7184 stats uri /admin?stats
7185 stats refresh 5s
7186
7187 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7188 global section.
7189
7190
7191stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007192 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7194 yes | yes | yes | yes
7195 Arguments : none
7196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007197 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007198 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7199 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7200 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7201 - IP (socket, server)
7202 - cookie (backend, server)
7203
7204 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7205 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007206 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007207
7208 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7209
7210
7211stats show-node [ <name> ]
7212 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007214 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007215 Arguments:
7216 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7217 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7218
7219 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7220 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007221 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007222
7223 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7224 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7225 unobvious parameters.
7226
7227 Example:
7228 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7229 backend private_monitoring
7230 stats enable
7231 stats show-node Europe-1
7232 stats uri /admin?stats
7233 stats refresh 5s
7234
7235 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7236 section.
7237
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007238
7239stats uri <prefix>
7240 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007242 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007243 Arguments :
7244 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7245 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7246 query string.
7247
7248 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7249 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7250 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7251 possible to reach it in the application.
7252
7253 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007254 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007255 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7256 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7257 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7258 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7259
7260 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7261 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7262 an address or a port to statistics only.
7263
7264 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7265 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7266 unobvious parameters.
7267
7268 Example :
7269 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7270 backend public_www
7271 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7272 stats enable
7273 stats hide-version
7274 stats scope .
7275 stats uri /admin?stats
7276 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7277 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7278 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7279
7280 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7281 backend private_monitoring
7282 stats enable
7283 stats uri /admin?stats
7284 stats refresh 5s
7285
7286 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7287
7288
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007289stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7290 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007292 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007293
7294 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007295 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007296 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7297 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7298 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7299
7300 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7301 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7302 the "stick-table" statement.
7303
7304 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7305 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7306 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7307 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7308 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7309
7310 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7311 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7312 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7313 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7314 transformation rules.
7315
7316 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7317 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7318 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7319 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7320 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7321 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7322 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7323
7324 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7325 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7326 ACL based conditions.
7327
7328 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7329 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7330 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7331 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7332
7333 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7334 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7335 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7336 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7337
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007338 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7339 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7340 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7341
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007342 Example :
7343 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7344 # last 30 minutes
7345 backend pop
7346 mode tcp
7347 balance roundrobin
7348 stick store-request src
7349 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7350 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7351 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7352
7353 backend smtp
7354 mode tcp
7355 balance roundrobin
7356 stick match src table pop
7357 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7358 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7359
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007360 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007361 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007362
7363
7364stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7365 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7367 no | no | yes | yes
7368
7369 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7370 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7371 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7372 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7373
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007374 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7375 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7376 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7377
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007378 Examples :
7379 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007380 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007381
7382 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7383 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7384 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7385
7386
7387 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7388 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7389 backend http
7390 mode http
7391 balance roundrobin
7392 stick on src table https
7393 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7394 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7395 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7396
7397 backend https
7398 mode tcp
7399 balance roundrobin
7400 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7401 stick on src
7402 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7403 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7404
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007405 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007406
7407
7408stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7409 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7411 no | no | yes | yes
7412
7413 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007414 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007415 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7416 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7417 server is selected.
7418
7419 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7420 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7421 the "stick-table" statement.
7422
7423 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7424 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7425 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7426 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7427 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7428 address.
7429
7430 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7431 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7432 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7433 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7434 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7435 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7436 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7437 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7438 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7439 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7440
7441 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7442 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7443 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7444 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7445 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7446 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7447 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7448
7449 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7450 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7451 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7452 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7453
7454 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7455 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7456 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7457 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7458 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7459 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007460 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7461 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7462 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7463 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7464 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7465 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007466
7467 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7468 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7469 the request.
7470
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007471 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7472 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7473 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7474
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007475 Example :
7476 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7477 # last 30 minutes
7478 backend pop
7479 mode tcp
7480 balance roundrobin
7481 stick store-request src
7482 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7483 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7484 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7485
7486 backend smtp
7487 mode tcp
7488 balance roundrobin
7489 stick match src table pop
7490 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7491 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7492
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007493 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007494 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007495
7496
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007497stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007498 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7499 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007500 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007502 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007503
7504 Arguments :
7505 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7506 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7507 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7508 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7509
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007510 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7511 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7512 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7513 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7514
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007515 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7516 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7517 instance.
7518
7519 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7520 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7521 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7522 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7523 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7524 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007525 to 32 characters.
7526
7527 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7528 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7529 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007530 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007531 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7532 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007533
7534 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007535 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7536 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007537 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7538 increase.
7539
7540 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007541 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7542 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7543 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007544
7545 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7546 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7547 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7548 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7549 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7550 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7551 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7552 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7553 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7554 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7555 parameter (see below).
7556
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007557 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7558 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7559 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7560 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7561 soft restart.
7562
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007563 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7564 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007565
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007566 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7567 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7568 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7569 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7570 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007571 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007572 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7573 if not expiration delay is specified.
7574
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007575 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7576 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7577 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7578 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007579 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7580 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7581 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7582 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7583 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7584 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7585 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7586 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7587 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7588 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7589 types and their arguments.
7590
7591 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7592 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7593 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7594 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7595
7596 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7597 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7598 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7599 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7600
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007601 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7602 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7603 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7604 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7605 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7606 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7607
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007608 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7609 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7610 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7611 they were received.
7612
7613 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7614 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7615 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7616 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7617 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7618
7619 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7620 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7621 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7622 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7623 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7624
7625 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7626 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7627 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7628
7629 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7630 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7631 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7632 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7633 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7634
7635 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7636 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7637 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7638 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7639 the client side.
7640
7641 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7642 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7643 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7644 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7645 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7646 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7647 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7648
7649 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7650 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7651 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7652 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7653 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7654 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7655 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7656
7657 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7658 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7659 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7660 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7661 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7662 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7663
7664 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7665 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7666 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7667 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7668
7669 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7670 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7671 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7672 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7673 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7674 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7675 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7676 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7677 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7678 recommended for better fairness.
7679
7680 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7681 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7682 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7683 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7684
7685 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7686 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7687 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7688 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7689 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7690 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7691 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7692 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7693 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7694 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007695
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007696 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7697 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007698 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7699 reference it.
7700
7701 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7702 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7703 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7704 as an exclusive stickiness.
7705
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007706 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7707 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7708 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7709 something that can be ignored.
7710
7711 Example:
7712 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7713 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7714 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7715 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7716
7717 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007718 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007719
7720
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007721stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7722 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7724 no | no | yes | yes
7725
7726 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007727 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007728 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7729 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7730 server is selected.
7731
7732 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7733 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7734 the "stick-table" statement.
7735
7736 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7737 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7738 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7739 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7740
7741 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7742 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7743 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7744 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7745 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7746 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007747 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007748 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7749 rules.
7750
7751 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7752 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7753 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7754 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7755 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7756 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7757 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7758
7759 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7760 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7761 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7762 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7763
7764 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7765 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7766 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7767 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7768 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7769 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007770 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7771 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7772 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7773 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7774 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7775 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7776 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7777 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7778 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007779
7780 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7781
7782 Example :
7783 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7784 backend https
7785 mode tcp
7786 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007787 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007788 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007789
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007790 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7791 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7792
7793 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7794 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7795 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7796
7797 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7798 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007799
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007800 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7801 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7802 # at offset 44.
7803
7804 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7805 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7806
7807 # Learn on response if server hello.
7808 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007809
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007810 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7811 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7812
7813 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7814 extraction.
7815
7816
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007817tcp-check connect [params*]
7818 Opens a new connection
7819 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7820 no | no | yes | yes
7821
7822 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7823 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7824 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7825
7826 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7827 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7828 of the sequence.
7829
7830 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7831 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7832 do.
7833
7834 Parameters :
7835 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7836 use the TCP connection.
7837
7838 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7839 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7840 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7841
7842 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7843
7844 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7845
7846 Examples:
7847 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7848 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7849 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7850 option tcp-check
7851 tcp-check connect
7852 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7853 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7854 tcp-check send \r\n
7855 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7856 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7857 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7858 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7859 tcp-check send \r\n
7860 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7861 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7862
7863 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7864 option tcp-check
7865 tcp-check connect port 110
7866 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7867 tcp-check connect port 143
7868 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7869 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7870
7871 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7872
7873
7874tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7875 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7876 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7877 no | no | yes | yes
7878
7879 Arguments :
7880 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7881 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7882 binary.
7883 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7884 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7885 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7886
7887 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7888 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7889 with the usual backslash ('\').
7890 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7891 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7892 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7893 used upper or lower case.
7894
7895
7896 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7897
7898 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7899 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7900 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7901 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7902 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7903 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7904 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7905 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7906
7907 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7908 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7909 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7910 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7911 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7912 expression.
7913
7914 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7915 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7916 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7917 this exact hexadecimal string.
7918 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7919
7920 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7921 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7922 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7923 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7924 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7925 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7926 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7927 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7928 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7929 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7930 the null character.
7931
7932 Examples :
7933 # perform a POP check
7934 option tcp-check
7935 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7936
7937 # perform an IMAP check
7938 option tcp-check
7939 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7940
7941 # look for the redis master server
7942 option tcp-check
7943 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7944 tcp-check expect +PONG
7945 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7946 tcp-check expect string role:master
7947 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7948 tcp-check expect string +OK
7949
7950
7951 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7952 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7953
7954
7955tcp-check send <data>
7956 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7957 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7958 no | no | yes | yes
7959
7960 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7961 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7962
7963 Examples :
7964 # look for the redis master server
7965 option tcp-check
7966 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7967 tcp-check expect string role:master
7968
7969 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7970 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7971
7972
7973tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7974 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7975 tcp health check
7976 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7977 no | no | yes | yes
7978
7979 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7980 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7981 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7982 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7983 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7984 hexadecimal string.
7985 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7986
7987 Examples :
7988 # redis check in binary
7989 option tcp-check
7990 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7991 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7992
7993
7994 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7995 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7996
7997
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007998tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7999 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8001 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008002 Arguments :
8003 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008004 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
8005 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008006
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008007 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008008
8009 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8010 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008011 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8012 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8013 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8014 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8015 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8016 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008018 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8019 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8020 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8021 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008022
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008023 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008024 - accept :
8025 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8026 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8027 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008028
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008029 - reject :
8030 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8031 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8032 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8033 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8034 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8035 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8036 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8037 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8038 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8039 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8040 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8041 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008042
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008043 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8044 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8045 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8046 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8047 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8048 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8049 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8050 hosts.
8051
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008052 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8053 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8054 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8055 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8056 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8057 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8058 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8059 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8060 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008061 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8062 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008063
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008064 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008065 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008066 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008067 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008068 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8069 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008070 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008071 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8072 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8073 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8074 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8075 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008076
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008077 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008078 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008079 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008080 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8081 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8082 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8083 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008084
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008085 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8086 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8087 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8088 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008089
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008090 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8091 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8092 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8093 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8094 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008095 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8096 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8097 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8098 layer7 information is extracted.
8099
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008100 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8101 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8102 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8103 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8104 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008105
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008106 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8107 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8108 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008109
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008110 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8111 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8112 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008113
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008114 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008115 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008116 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008118 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8119 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8120 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008121
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008122 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008123 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8124 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008125
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008126 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8127
8128 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8129
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008130 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008132 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008133
8134
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008135tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8136 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008138 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008139 Arguments :
8140 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008141 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008142 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
8143 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008144
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008145 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008146
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008147 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8148 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8149 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8150 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8151 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008152
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008153 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8154 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8155 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8156 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008157 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8158 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8159 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8160 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8161 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8162 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008163 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008164 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008165
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008166 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8167 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8168 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8169 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008170
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008171 Four types of actions are supported :
8172 - accept : the request is accepted
8173 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8174 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008175 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008176
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008177 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8178 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008179
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008180 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8181 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8182 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8183 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8184 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8185 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008186
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008187 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008188 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8189 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008190
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008191 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008192 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8193 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8194 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8195 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008196 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8197 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8198 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008199
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008200 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008201 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8202 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8203 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008204
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008205 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8206 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8207 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8208 documentation.
8209
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008210 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008211 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8212 # and reject everything else.
8213 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8214 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008215 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008216 tcp-request content reject
8217
8218 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008219 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8220 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8221 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008222 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008223
8224 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8225 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8226 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008227 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008228 tcp-request content reject
8229
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008230 Example:
8231 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8232 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008233 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008234
8235 Example:
8236 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8237 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008238 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008239
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008240 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8241 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8242
8243 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008244 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008245 # protecting all our sites
8246 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008247 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8248 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008249 ...
8250 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8251
8252 backend http_dynamic
8253 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008254 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008255 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008256 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8257 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8258 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008259 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008261 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008263 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008264
8265
8266tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8267 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008269 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008270 Arguments :
8271 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8272 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8273 as explained at the top of this document.
8274
8275 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8276 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8277 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8278 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8279 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8280
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008281 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8282 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8283 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8284 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8285
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008286 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8287 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008288 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008289 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008290 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8291 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8292 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8293 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008294
8295 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8296 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8297 it pass through unaffected.
8298
8299 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8300 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8301 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008302 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008303 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8304 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008305 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8306 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8307 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008308
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008309 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008310 "timeout client".
8311
8312
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008313tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8314 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8316 no | no | yes | yes
8317 Arguments :
8318 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008319 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008320
8321 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8322
8323 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8324 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8325 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008326 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8327 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008328
8329 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8330
8331 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8332 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8333 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8334 inserted.
8335
8336 Two types of actions are supported :
8337 - accept :
8338 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8339 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8340 the rules evaluation.
8341
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008342 - close :
8343 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8344 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8345 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8346 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8347 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8348 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008349 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008350 protocols.
8351
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008352 - reject :
8353 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8354 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008355 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008356
8357 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8358 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8359 for changing the default action to a reject.
8360
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008361 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8362 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8363 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8364 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008365 period.
8366
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008367 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8368 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8369 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8370 documentation.
8371
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008372 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8373
8374 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8375
8376
8377tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8378 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8380 no | no | yes | yes
8381 Arguments :
8382 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8383 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8384 as explained at the top of this document.
8385
8386 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8387
8388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008389timeout check <timeout>
8390 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8391 established.
8392
8393 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8394 yes | no | yes | yes
8395 Arguments:
8396 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8397 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8398 as explained at the top of this document.
8399
8400 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8401 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8402 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8403 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008404 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8405 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8406 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008407
8408 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8409 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8410
8411 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8412 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008413 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008414
8415 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8416 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8417 forget about it.
8418
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008419 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8420 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008421
8422
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008423timeout client <timeout>
8424timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8425 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8427 yes | yes | yes | no
8428 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008429 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008430 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8431 as explained at the top of this document.
8432
8433 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8434 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8435 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8436 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8437 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8438 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8439 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8440 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008441 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008442 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008443 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8444 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008445 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8446 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008447
8448 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8449 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8450 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8451 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8452 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8453 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8454
8455 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8456 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8457 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8458
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008459 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008460
8461
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008462timeout client-fin <timeout>
8463 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8465 yes | yes | yes | no
8466 Arguments :
8467 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8468 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8469 as explained at the top of this document.
8470
8471 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8472 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8473 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8474 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8475 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8476 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8477 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8478 down in one direction.
8479
8480 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8481 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8482 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8483
8484 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8485
8486
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008487timeout connect <timeout>
8488timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8489 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8491 yes | no | yes | yes
8492 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008493 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008494 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8495 as explained at the top of this document.
8496
8497 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008498 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008499 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008500 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008501 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8502 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008503
8504 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8505 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8506 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8507 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8508 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8509 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8510
8511 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8512 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8513 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8514
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008515 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8516 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008517
8518
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008519timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8520 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8522 yes | yes | yes | yes
8523 Arguments :
8524 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8525 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8526 as explained at the top of this document.
8527
8528 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8529 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8530 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8531 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8532 once the request has started to present itself.
8533
8534 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8535 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8536 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8537 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8538 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8539
8540 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8541 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8542 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8543 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8544
8545 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8546 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8547 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8548 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8549 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008550 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008551
8552 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8553 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8554 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8555 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8556
8557 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8558
8559
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008560timeout http-request <timeout>
8561 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008563 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008564 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008565 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008566 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8567 as explained at the top of this document.
8568
8569 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8570 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8571 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8572 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8573 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8574 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8575 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008576 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8577 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8578 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8579 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8580 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008581 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8582 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008583
8584 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8585 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008586 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8587 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008588
8589 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8590 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8591 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8592 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8593 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8594
8595 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008596 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8597 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8598 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008599
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008600 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8601 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008602
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008603
8604timeout queue <timeout>
8605 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8607 yes | no | yes | yes
8608 Arguments :
8609 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8610 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8611 as explained at the top of this document.
8612
8613 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8614 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8615 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8616 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8617 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8618
8619 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8620 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8621 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8622 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8623
8624 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8625
8626
8627timeout server <timeout>
8628timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8629 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8631 yes | no | yes | yes
8632 Arguments :
8633 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8634 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8635 as explained at the top of this document.
8636
8637 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8638 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8639 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8640 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8641 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8642 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8643 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8644
8645 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8646 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8647 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8648 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8649 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008650 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008651 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008652 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8653 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8654 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8655 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008656
8657 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8658 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8659 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8660 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8661 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8662 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8663
8664 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8665 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8666 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8667
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008668 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008669
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008670
8671timeout server-fin <timeout>
8672 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8674 yes | no | yes | yes
8675 Arguments :
8676 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8677 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8678 as explained at the top of this document.
8679
8680 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8681 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8682 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8683 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8684 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8685 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8686 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8687 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8688 situations, it should not be needed.
8689
8690 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8691 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8692 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8693
8694 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8695
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008696
8697timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008698 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8700 yes | yes | yes | yes
8701 Arguments :
8702 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8703 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8704 as explained at the top of this document.
8705
8706 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8707 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8708 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8709
8710 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8711 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8712 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8713 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008714 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008715
8716 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8717
8718
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008719timeout tunnel <timeout>
8720 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8722 yes | no | yes | yes
8723 Arguments :
8724 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8725 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8726 as explained at the top of this document.
8727
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008728 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008729 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8730 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8731 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8732 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8733 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8734 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8735 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8736 specified.
8737
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008738 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8739 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8740 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8741 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8742 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8743 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8744 state.
8745
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008746 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8747 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8748 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8749 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8750 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8751
8752 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8753 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8754 forget about it.
8755
8756 Example :
8757 defaults http
8758 option http-server-close
8759 timeout connect 5s
8760 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008761 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008762 timeout server 30s
8763 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8764
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008765 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008766
8767
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008768transparent (deprecated)
8769 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008771 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008772 Arguments : none
8773
8774 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8775 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8776 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8777 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8778 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8779 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8780 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8781 appropriate server.
8782
8783 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8784
8785 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8786 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8787
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008788 See also: "option transparent"
8789
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008790unique-id-format <string>
8791 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8793 yes | yes | yes | no
8794 Arguments :
8795 <string> is a log-format string.
8796
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008797 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8798 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8799 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8800 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008801
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008802 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8803 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8804 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8805 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8806 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8807 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8808 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8809 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008810
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008811 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8812 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008813
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008814 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008815
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008816 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008817
8818 will generate:
8819
8820 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8821
8822 See also: "unique-id-header"
8823
8824unique-id-header <name>
8825 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8827 yes | yes | yes | no
8828 Arguments :
8829 <name> is the name of the header.
8830
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008831 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8832 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008833
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008834 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008835
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008836 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008837 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8838
8839 will generate:
8840
8841 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8842
8843 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008844
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008845use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008846 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8848 no | yes | yes | no
8849 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008850 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8851 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008852
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008853 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8854 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008855
8856 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8857 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8858 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008859 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8860 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8861 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8862 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008863
8864 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8865 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8866 assign the backend.
8867
8868 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8869 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8870 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8871 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8872 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8873 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8874
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008875 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008876 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008877 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8878 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8879 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8880
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008881 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8882 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8883 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8884 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8885 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8886 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8887 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8888 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8889 cannot be forced from the request.
8890
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008891 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008892 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8893 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8894
8895 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8896 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008897
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008898
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008899use-server <server> if <condition>
8900use-server <server> unless <condition>
8901 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8903 no | no | yes | yes
8904 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008905 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008906
8907 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8908
8909 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8910 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8911 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8912
8913 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8914 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8915 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8916 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8917 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8918 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8919 matches will assign the server.
8920
8921 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8922 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8923 with the next rules until one matches.
8924
8925 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8926 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8927 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8928 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8929
8930 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8931 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8932 stripped.
8933
8934 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8935 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8936 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8937 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8938
8939 Example :
8940 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8941 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8942 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8943 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8944 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8945 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8946 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8947 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8948 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8949
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008950 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008951
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008952
89535. Bind and Server options
8954--------------------------
8955
8956The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8957depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8958settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8959written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8960described in this section.
8961
8962
89635.1. Bind options
8964-----------------
8965
8966The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8967as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8968no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8969parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8970while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8971provided immediately after the setting name.
8972
8973The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8974
8975accept-proxy
8976 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008977 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8978 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008979 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8980 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8981 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8982 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8983 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8984 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8985 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008986 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8987 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008988
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008989alpn <protocols>
8990 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8991 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8992 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8993 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8994 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8995 initial NPN extension.
8996
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008997backlog <backlog>
8998 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8999 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9000
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009001ecdhe <named curve>
9002 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009003 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9004 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009005
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009006ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009007 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9008 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9009 client's certificate.
9010
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009011ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9012 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9013 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9014 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9015 error is ignored.
9016
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009017ciphers <ciphers>
9018 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9019 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009020 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009021 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9022 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9023
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009024crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009025 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9026 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9027 to verify client's certificate.
9028
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009029crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009030 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9031 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9032 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9033 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9034 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9035 file.
9036
9037 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9038 are loaded.
9039
9040 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009041 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009042 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9043 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9044 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9045 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9046 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9047 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9048 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009049
9050 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9051 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9052 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9053 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009054 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9055 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009056
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009057 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009058
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009059 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9060 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009061 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009062 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9063 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9064 clients).
9065
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009066 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9067 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9068 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9069 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9070 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9071 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9072 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9073 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9074 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9075 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9076 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9077 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9078 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9079
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009080 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9081 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9082 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9083 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9084 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9085
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009086crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009087 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9088 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009089 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009090 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009091
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009092crt-list <file>
9093 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009094 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9095 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009096
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009097 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009098
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009099 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9100 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9101 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9102 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9103 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9104 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9105 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9106 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009107
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009108defer-accept
9109 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9110 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9111 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9112 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9113 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9114 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9115 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9116 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9117 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9118 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9119 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9120
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009121force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009122 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009123 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009124 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9125 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009126
9127force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009128 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009129 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9130 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009131
9132force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009133 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009134 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9135 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009136
9137force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009138 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009139 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9140 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009141
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009142gid <gid>
9143 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9144 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9145 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9146 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9147 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9148
9149group <group>
9150 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9151 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9152 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9153 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9154 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9155
9156id <id>
9157 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9158 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9159 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9160 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9161
9162interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009163 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9164 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9165 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9166 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9167 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9168 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9169 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009170
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009171level <level>
9172 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9173 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9174 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9175 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9176 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9177 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9178 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9179 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9180 counters).
9181 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9182 all counters).
9183
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009184maxconn <maxconn>
9185 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9186 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9187 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9188 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9189 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9190 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9191 eat all memory.
9192
9193mode <mode>
9194 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9195 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9196 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9197 UNIX sockets.
9198
9199mss <maxseg>
9200 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9201 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9202 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9203 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9204 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9205 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9206 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9207 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9208 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9209 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9210 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9211
9212name <name>
9213 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9214 page.
9215
9216nice <nice>
9217 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9218 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9219 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9220 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9221 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9222 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9223 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9224 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9225 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9226 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9227 one for an RDP socket.
9228
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009229no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009230 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009231 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009232 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009233 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9234 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009235 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009236
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009237no-tls-tickets
9238 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9239 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9240 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009241 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9242 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009243
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009244no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009245 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009246 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009247 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009248 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9249 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9250 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009251
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009252no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009254 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009255 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009256 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9257 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9258 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009259
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009260no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009261 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009262 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009263 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009264 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9265 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9266 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009267
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009268npn <protocols>
9269 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9270 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9271 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9272 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009273 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9274 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009275
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009276process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9277 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9278 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9279 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9280 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9281 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9282 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9283 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009284 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9285 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9286 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9287 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9288 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9289 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9290 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009291
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009292ssl
9293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009294 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009295 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9296 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9297 to deciphered contents.
9298
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009299strict-sni
9300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9301 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9302 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9303 See the "crt" option for more information.
9304
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009305tcp-ut <delay>
9306 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9307 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9308 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9309 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9310 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9311 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9312 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9313 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9314 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9315 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9316 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9317
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009318tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009319 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009320 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9321 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9322 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9323 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9324 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9325 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9326 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009327 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9328 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9329 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009330
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009331tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9332 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9333 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9334 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9335 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9336 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9337 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9338 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9339 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9340 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9341 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9342
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009343transparent
9344 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9345 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9346 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9347 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9348 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9349 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9350 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9351 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9352 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9353 so check for support with your vendor.
9354
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009355v4v6
9356 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9357 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9358 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9359 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009360 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009361
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009362v6only
9363 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9364 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9365 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009366 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9367 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009368
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009369uid <uid>
9370 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9371 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9372 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9373 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9374 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9375
9376user <user>
9377 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9378 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9379 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9380 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9381 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9382
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009383verify [none|optional|required]
9384 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9385 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9386 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9387 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9388 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009389 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9390 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9391 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9392 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009393
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020093945.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009395------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009397The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9398which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9399arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9400settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9401after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9402Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9403address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009405 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009406 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009408The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009409
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009410addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009411 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9412 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9413 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9414 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9415 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009417 Supported in default-server: No
9418
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009419agent-check
9420 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009421 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9422 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9423 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9424 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009425
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009426 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009427 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009428 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9429 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9430 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009431
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009432 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9433 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009434
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009435 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9436 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9437 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009438
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009439 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9440 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9441 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009442
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009443 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9444 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9445 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9446 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9447 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9448 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9449 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009450
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009451 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9452 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009453
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009454 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9455 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9456 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9457 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9458 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9459 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9460 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9461 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9462 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009463
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009464 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9465 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009466 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9467 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9468 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9469 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009470
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009471 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9472 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009473
9474 Supported in default-server: No
9475
9476agent-inter <delay>
9477 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9478 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9479
9480 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9481 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9482 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9483 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9484 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9485 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9486 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9487 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9488 of backends use the same servers.
9489
9490 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9491
9492 Supported in default-server: Yes
9493
9494agent-port <port>
9495 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9496
9497 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9498
9499 Supported in default-server: Yes
9500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009501backup
9502 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9503 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9504 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9505 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9506 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9507 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009508
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009509 Supported in default-server: No
9510
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009511ca-file <cafile>
9512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9513 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9514 server's certificate.
9515
9516 Supported in default-server: No
9517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009518check
9519 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009520 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9521 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9522 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9523 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9524 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9525 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9526 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009527 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9528 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9529 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009530
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009531 Supported in default-server: No
9532
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009533check-send-proxy
9534 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9535 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9536 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9537 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9538 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9539 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9540 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9541
9542 Supported in default-server: No
9543
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009544check-ssl
9545 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9546 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9547 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9548 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009549 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009550 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9551 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9552 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9553 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9554
9555 Supported in default-server: No
9556
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009557ciphers <ciphers>
9558 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009559 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009560 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9561 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9562 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9563 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9564 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9565 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9566
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009567 Supported in default-server: No
9568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009569cookie <value>
9570 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9571 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9572 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9573 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9574 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9575 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9576 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9577
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009578 Supported in default-server: No
9579
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009580crl-file <crlfile>
9581 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9582 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9583 to verify server's certificate.
9584
9585 Supported in default-server: No
9586
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009587crt <cert>
9588 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9589 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9590 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9591 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9592 certificate request.
9593
9594 Supported in default-server: No
9595
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009596disabled
9597 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9598 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9599 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9600 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9601 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9602
9603 Supported in default-server: No
9604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009605error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009606 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9607 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9608 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009610 Supported in default-server: Yes
9611
9612 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009614fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009615 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9616 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9617 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9618
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009619 Supported in default-server: Yes
9620
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009621force-sslv3
9622 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9623 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009624 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9625 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009626
9627 Supported in default-server: No
9628
9629force-tlsv10
9630 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009631 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9632 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009633
9634 Supported in default-server: No
9635
9636force-tlsv11
9637 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009638 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9639 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009640
9641 Supported in default-server: No
9642
9643force-tlsv12
9644 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009645 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9646 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009647
9648 Supported in default-server: No
9649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009650id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009651 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9652 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9653 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009655 Supported in default-server: No
9656
9657inter <delay>
9658fastinter <delay>
9659downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009660 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9661 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9662 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9663 between checks depending on the server state :
9664
9665 Server state | Interval used
9666 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9667 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9668 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9669 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9670 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9671 or yet unchecked. |
9672 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9673 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9674 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009676 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9677 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9678 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9679 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009680 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9681 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9682 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9683 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9684 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009686 Supported in default-server: Yes
9687
9688maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009689 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9690 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9691 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9692 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9693 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9694 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9695 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9696 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009698 Supported in default-server: Yes
9699
9700maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009701 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9702 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9703 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9704 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9705 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9706 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9707 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009709 Supported in default-server: Yes
9710
9711minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009712 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9713 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9714 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9715 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9716 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9717 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009718 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009719 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009721 Supported in default-server: Yes
9722
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009723no-ssl-reuse
9724 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9725 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9726 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9727 and for paranoid users.
9728
9729 Supported in default-server: No
9730
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009731no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009732 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9733 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009734 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009735
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009736 Supported in default-server: No
9737
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009738no-tls-tickets
9739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9740 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9741 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009742 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9743 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009744
9745 Supported in default-server: No
9746
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009747no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009748 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009749 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9750 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009751 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9752 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9753 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009754
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009755 Supported in default-server: No
9756
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009757no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009758 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009759 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9760 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009761 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9762 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9763 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009764
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009765 Supported in default-server: No
9766
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009767no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009768 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009769 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9770 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009771 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9772 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9773 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009774
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009775 Supported in default-server: No
9776
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009777non-stick
9778 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9779 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9780 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9781
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009782 Supported in default-server: No
9783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009784observe <mode>
9785 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9786 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9787 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9788 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9789 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9790 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009791 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009792
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009793 Supported in default-server: No
9794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009795 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9796
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009797on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009798 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9799 Currently, four modes are available:
9800 - fastinter: force fastinter
9801 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9802 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9803 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9804 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9805
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009806 Supported in default-server: Yes
9807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009808 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9809
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009810on-marked-down <action>
9811 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9812 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009813 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9814 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9815 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9816 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9817 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9818 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9819 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9820 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009821
9822 Actions are disabled by default
9823
9824 Supported in default-server: Yes
9825
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009826on-marked-up <action>
9827 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9828 Currently one action is available:
9829 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9830 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9831 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9832 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9833 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9834 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9835 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9836 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9837
9838 Actions are disabled by default
9839
9840 Supported in default-server: Yes
9841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009842port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009843 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9844 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9845 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9846 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9847 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9848 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9849
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009850 Supported in default-server: Yes
9851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009852redir <prefix>
9853 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9854 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9855 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9856 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9857 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9858 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9859 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9860 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009861 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009862 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9863 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9864 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9865 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9866 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9867
9868 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9869
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009870 Supported in default-server: No
9871
9872rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009873 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9874 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9875 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009877 Supported in default-server: Yes
9878
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009879send-proxy
9880 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9881 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9882 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9883 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9884 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9885 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9886 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9887 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9888 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009889 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9890 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9891 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9892 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9893 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009894
9895 Supported in default-server: No
9896
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009897send-proxy-v2
9898 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9899 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9900 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9901 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9902 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9903 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9904 option of the "bind" keyword.
9905
9906 Supported in default-server: No
9907
9908send-proxy-v2-ssl
9909 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9910 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9911 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9912 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9913 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9914 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9915 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9916 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9917
9918 Supported in default-server: No
9919
9920send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9921 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9922 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9923 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9924 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9925 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9926 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9927 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9928 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9929 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9930
9931 Supported in default-server: No
9932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009933slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009934 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9935 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9936 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9937 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9938 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9939 parameters :
9940
9941 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9942 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9943
9944 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9945 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9946 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9947 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9948
9949 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9950 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9951 seen as failed.
9952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009953 Supported in default-server: Yes
9954
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009955source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009956source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009957source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009958 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9959 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9960 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9961 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9962
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009963 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9964 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9965 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9966 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9967 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9968 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9969 server.
9970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009971 Supported in default-server: No
9972
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009973ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009974 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9975 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9976 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9977 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9978 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9979 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009980 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009981
9982 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009984track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009985 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9986 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9987 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9988 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009989 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009991 Supported in default-server: No
9992
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009993verify [none|required]
9994 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009995 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9996 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9997 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9998 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009999 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10000 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10001 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010002
10003 Supported in default-server: No
10004
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010005verifyhost <hostname>
10006 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10007 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10008 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10009 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10010 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10011 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10012
10013 Supported in default-server: No
10014
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010015weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010016 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10017 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10018 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010019 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10020 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10021 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10022 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10023 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10024 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010025
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010026 Supported in default-server: Yes
10027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010028
100296. HTTP header manipulation
10030---------------------------
10031
10032In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10033response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10034request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10035which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010036against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010037
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010038If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10039to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10040but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10041HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10042stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10043because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10044a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10045still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010047This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10048in section 4.2 :
10049
10050 - reqadd <string>
10051 - reqallow <search>
10052 - reqiallow <search>
10053 - reqdel <search>
10054 - reqidel <search>
10055 - reqdeny <search>
10056 - reqideny <search>
10057 - reqpass <search>
10058 - reqipass <search>
10059 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10060 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10061 - reqtarpit <search>
10062 - reqitarpit <search>
10063 - rspadd <string>
10064 - rspdel <search>
10065 - rspidel <search>
10066 - rspdeny <search>
10067 - rspideny <search>
10068 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10069 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10070
10071With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10072is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10073parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10074prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10075Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10076
10077 \t for a tab
10078 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10079 \n for a new line (LF)
10080 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10081 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10082 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10083 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10084 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10085
10086The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10087portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10088above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10089regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
100909 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10091is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10092
10093The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10094after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10095
10096Notes related to these keywords :
10097---------------------------------
10098 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10099 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10100 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10101
10102 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10103 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10104 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10105
10106 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10107 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10108 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10109 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10110 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10111
10112 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10113 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10114 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10115 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10116 useless headers before adding new ones.
10117
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010118 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010119 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10120
10121 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10122 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10123 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10124
10125 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10126 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010127 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010128
10129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101307. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10131----------------------------------
10132
10133Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10134client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10135The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10136these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10137but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10138data called patterns.
10139
10140
101417.1. ACL basics
10142---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010143
10144The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10145content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10146from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10147simple :
10148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010149 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010150 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010151 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10152 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010154The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10155adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010156
10157In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010159 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010160
10161This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10162Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10163and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010164an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10165conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10166as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10167are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010168
10169ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10170'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10171which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10172
10173There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10174performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010176The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10177specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10178this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010179methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10180ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010181
10182Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10183 - boolean
10184 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10185 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10186 - string
10187 - data block
10188
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010189Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10190converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10191would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10192The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10193which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10194
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010195Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10196keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10197fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10198which are summarized in the table below :
10199
10200 +---------------------+-----------------+
10201 | Sample or converter | Default |
10202 | output type | matching method |
10203 +---------------------+-----------------+
10204 | boolean | bool |
10205 +---------------------+-----------------+
10206 | integer | int |
10207 +---------------------+-----------------+
10208 | ip | ip |
10209 +---------------------+-----------------+
10210 | string | str |
10211 +---------------------+-----------------+
10212 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10213 +---------------------+-----------------+
10214
10215Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10216matching method, see below.
10217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010218The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10219 - boolean
10220 - integer or integer range
10221 - IP address / network
10222 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10223 - regular expression
10224 - hex block
10225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010226The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10227
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010228 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10229 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010230 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010231 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010232 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010233 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010234 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010236The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10237read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10238if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10239lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10240will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10241beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10242a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10243lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10244exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10245
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010246The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10247parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10248ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10249a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10250check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10251
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010252The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10253socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10254file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010256Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10257loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10258
10259 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10260
10261In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10262the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10263case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10264as well.
10265
10266The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10267sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10268do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10269methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10270is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10271obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10272followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10273default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10274that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10275string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10276
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010277The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10278By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10279string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10280resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10281server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10282waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10283flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10284function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010286There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10287sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10288be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010289
10290 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10291 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010292 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10293 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10294 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10295 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010296
10297 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10298 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010299 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010300
10301 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010302 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010303
10304 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010305 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010306
10307 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10308 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10309
10310 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10311 binary or string samples.
10312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010313 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10314 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010316 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10317 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10318 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010320 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10321 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010323 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10324 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010326 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10327 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010329 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10330 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010331 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010333 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10334 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10335 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010336
10337For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10338request, it is possible to do :
10339
10340 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10341
10342In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10343buffer, one would use the following acl :
10344
10345 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10346
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010347On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10348possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10349
10350 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010352All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10353criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10354method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10355to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10356criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10357the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010359If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010360the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10361For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010363 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10364 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10365 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10366 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010367
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010368
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010369The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10370types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10371combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10372brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10373default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010375 +-------------------------------------------------+
10376 | Input sample type |
10377 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010378 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010379 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10380 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10381 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010382 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010383 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010384 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010385 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010386 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010387 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010388 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010389 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010390 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010391 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010392 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010393 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010394 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010395 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010396 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010397 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010398 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010399 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010400 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010401 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010402 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010403 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10404 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10405 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010406
10407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104087.1.1. Matching booleans
10409------------------------
10410
10411In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10412Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10413When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10414that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10415
10416Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10417return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10418"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10419
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104217.1.2. Matching integers
10422------------------------
10423
10424Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10425enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10426to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10427
10428Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10429matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10430lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010431
10432For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10433unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10434representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10435
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010436As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10437two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10438instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10439ranges and operators.
10440
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010441For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010442operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10443Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10444of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010445
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010446Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010447
10448 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10449 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10450 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10451 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10452 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10453
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010454For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010455
10456 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10457
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010458This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10459
10460 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104637.1.3. Matching strings
10464-----------------------
10465
10466String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10467different forms :
10468
10469 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10470 patterns ;
10471
10472 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10473 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10474
10475 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10476 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10477
10478 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10479 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10480
10481 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10482 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10483 matches.
10484
10485 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10486 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10487 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010488
10489String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10490exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10491characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10492string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10493to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010494before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010495
10496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104977.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10498---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010499
10500Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10501they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10502possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10503passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10504the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010505the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10506match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010507
10508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200105097.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10510-------------------------------------
10511
10512It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10513not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10514a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10515to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10516digits may be used upper or lower case.
10517
10518Example :
10519 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10520 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10521
10522
105237.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10524---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010525
10526IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10527netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10528within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010529host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010530difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10531at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10532does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10533parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010534
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010535IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10536Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10537trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10538IPv6 patterns.
10539
10540HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10541following situations :
10542 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10543 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10544 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10545 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10546 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10547 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10548 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10549 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10550 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10551 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010553
105547.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10555----------------------------------
10556
10557Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10558combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10559
10560 - AND (implicit)
10561 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10562 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010564A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010566 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010568Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10569indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010571For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10572"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10573requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10574is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10575
10576 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10577 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10578 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10579 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10580
10581To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10582and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10583
10584 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10585 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10586 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10587 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10588
10589 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10590 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10591 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10592 use_backend www if host_www
10593
10594It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10595expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10596be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10597the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10598
10599 The following rule :
10600
10601 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10602 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10603
10604 Can also be written that way :
10605
10606 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10607
10608It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10609to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10610simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10611sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10612good use is the following :
10613
10614 With named ACLs :
10615
10616 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10617 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10618 monitor fail if site_dead
10619
10620 With anonymous ACLs :
10621
10622 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10623
10624See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10625
10626
106277.3. Fetching samples
10628---------------------
10629
10630Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10631against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10632sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10633ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10634of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10635available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10636
10637This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10638Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10639compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10640deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10641
10642The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10643matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10644method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10645indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10646
10647As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10648when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10649mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10650the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10651ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10652
10653Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10654multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10655when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10656incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10657are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10658is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10659all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10660
10661Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10662 - name
10663 - name(arg1)
10664 - name(arg1,arg2)
10665
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010666
106677.3.1. Converters
10668-----------------
10669
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010670Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10671of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10672is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10673was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10674has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10675unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10676
10677These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10678sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10679the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10680support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010681
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010682A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10683support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10684supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10685(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10686bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010688The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010689
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010690add(<value>)
10691 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10692 result as an unsigned integer.
10693
10694and(<value>)
10695 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10696 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10697
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010698base64
10699 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10700 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10701 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10702
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010703bool
10704 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10705 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10706 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10707 presence of a flag).
10708
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010709bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10710 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10711 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10712 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10713
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010714cpl
10715 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10716 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10717
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010718crc32([<avalanche>])
10719 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10720 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10721 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10722 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10723 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10724 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10725 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10726 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10727 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10728 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10729 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10730
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020010731da-csv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
10732 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
10733 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
10734 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
10735 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
10736 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
10737 configuration language.
10738
10739 Example:
10740 frontend www
10741 bind *:8881
10742 default_backend servers
10743 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
10744
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010745div(<value>)
10746 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10747 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10748 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10749
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010750djb2([<avalanche>])
10751 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10752 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10753 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10754 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10755 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10756 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10757 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010758 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10759 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010760
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010761even
10762 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10763 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10764
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010765field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10766 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10767 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10768 list of chars.
10769
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010770hex
10771 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10772 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10773 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10774 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010775
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010776http_date([<offset>])
10777 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10778 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10779 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10780 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10781 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10782 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010783
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010784in_table(<table>)
10785 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10786 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10787 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10788 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10789 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10790
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010791ipmask(<mask>)
10792 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10793 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10794 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10795 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10796
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010797json([<input-code>])
10798 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10799 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10800 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10801 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10802 of errors:
10803 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10804 bytes, ...)
10805 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10806 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10807
10808 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10809 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10810 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10811 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10812 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10813 are :
10814 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10815 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10816 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10817 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10818 error ;
10819 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10820 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10821
10822 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10823 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10824
10825 Example:
10826 capture request header user-agent len 150
10827 capture request header Host len 15
10828 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10829
10830 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10831 GET / HTTP/1.0
10832 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10833
10834 Output log:
10835 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10836
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010837language(<value>[,<default>])
10838 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10839 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10840 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10841 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10842 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10843 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10844 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10845 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10846 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10847 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10848 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10849 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010850
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010851 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010852
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010853 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10854 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010855
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010856 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10857 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10858 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10859 use_backend spanish if es
10860 use_backend french if fr
10861 use_backend english if en
10862 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010863
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010864lower
10865 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10866 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10867 type. The result is of type string.
10868
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010869ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10870 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10871 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10872 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10873 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10874 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10875 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10876
10877 Example :
10878
10879 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10880 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10881 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10882
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010883map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10884map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10885map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10886 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10887 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10888 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10889 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10890 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10891 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10892 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10893 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010894
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010895 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10896 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10897 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010898
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010899 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10900 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010901
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010902 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10903 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10904 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10905 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010906 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10907 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010908 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10909 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10910 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10911 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10912 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10913 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10914 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10915 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10916 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10917 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10918 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10919 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10920 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10921 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010922
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010923 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10924 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10925 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10926 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10927 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010928
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010929 Example :
10930
10931 # this is a comment and is ignored
10932 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10933 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10934 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10935 | | | `---------- value
10936 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10937 | `---------------------------- key
10938 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10939
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010940mod(<value>)
10941 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10942 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
10943
10944mul(<value>)
10945 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
10946 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
10947 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
10948
10949neg
10950 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
10951 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
10952 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
10953 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10954
10955not
10956 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10957 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10958 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10959 absence of a flag).
10960
10961odd
10962 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
10963 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
10964
10965or(<value>)
10966 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10967 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10968
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010010969regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010010970 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
10971 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
10972 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
10973 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
10974 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
10975 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
10976 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
10977 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
10978 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
10979 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
10980 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
10981 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
10982 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
10983
10984 Example :
10985
10986 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
10987 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
10988 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
10989 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
10990
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020010991capture-req(<id>)
10992 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
10993 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
10994
10995 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
10996 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
10997 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
10998
10999capture-res(<id>)
11000 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11001 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11002
11003 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11004 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11005 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11006
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011007sdbm([<avalanche>])
11008 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
11009 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11010 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11011 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11012 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11013 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11014 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011015 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
11016 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011017
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011018sub(<value>)
11019 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
11020 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
11021 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
11022
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011023table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
11024 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11025 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11026 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
11027 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11028 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11029 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
11030
11031
11032table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
11033 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11034 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11035 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
11036 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11037 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11038 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
11039
11040table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11041 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11042 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11043 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11044 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11045 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11046
11047table_conn_cur(<table>)
11048 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11049 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11050 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11051 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11052 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11053
11054table_conn_rate(<table>)
11055 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11056 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11057 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11058 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11059 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11060
11061table_gpc0(<table>)
11062 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11063 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11064 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11065 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11066 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11067
11068table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11069 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11070 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11071 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11072 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11073 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11074 sample fetch keyword.
11075
11076table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11077 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11078 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11079 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11080 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11081 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11082
11083table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11084 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11085 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11086 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11087 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11088 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11089 keyword.
11090
11091table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11092 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11093 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11094 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11095 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11096 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11097
11098table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11099 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11100 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11101 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11102 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11103 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11104 keyword.
11105
11106table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11107 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11108 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11109 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11110 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11111 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11112 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11113 keyword.
11114
11115table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11116 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11117 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11118 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11119 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11120 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11121 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11122 keyword.
11123
11124table_server_id(<table>)
11125 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11126 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11127 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
11128 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
11129 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
11130 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
11131
11132table_sess_cnt(<table>)
11133 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11134 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11135 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11136 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
11137 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11138 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
11139 keyword.
11140
11141table_sess_rate(<table>)
11142 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11143 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11144 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
11145 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
11146 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11147 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
11148 keyword.
11149
11150table_trackers(<table>)
11151 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11152 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11153 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11154 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
11155 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
11156 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
11157 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
11158 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
11159 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
11160 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
11161
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011162upper
11163 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
11164 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11165 type. The result is of type string.
11166
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020011167url_dec
11168 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
11169 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
11170
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011171utime(<format>[,<offset>])
11172 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11173 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
11174 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11175 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11176 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11177 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
11178
11179 Example :
11180
11181 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
11182 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11183 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11184
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010011185word(<index>,<delimiters>)
11186 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
11187 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
11188
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011189wt6([<avalanche>])
11190 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
11191 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11192 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11193 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11194 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11195 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11196 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011197 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
11198 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011199
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011200xor(<value>)
11201 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
11202 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11203
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011204
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200112057.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011206--------------------------------------------
11207
11208A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11209not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11210"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11211The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11212
11213always_false : boolean
11214 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11215 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11216
11217always_true : boolean
11218 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11219 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11220
11221avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011222 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011223 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11224 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11225 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11226 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11227 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11228 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11229 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11230 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11231 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11232 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11233 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11234 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11235 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011237be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011238 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11239 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11240 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11241 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11242 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011244be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11245 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11246 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11247 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11248 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11249 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11250 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011251
11252 Example :
11253 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11254 backend dynamic
11255 mode http
11256 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11257 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011259connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11260 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011261 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011262 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11263 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011264
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011265 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011266 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011267 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11268
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011269 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11270 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011271
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011272 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011273 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011274 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011275 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11276 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011277 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011278 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011279
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011280 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11281 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011282 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011283 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011284
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011285date([<offset>]) : integer
11286 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11287 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11288 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11289 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011290 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11291
11292 Example :
11293
11294 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11295 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011296
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011297env(<name>) : string
11298 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11299 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11300 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11301 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11302 certain way.
11303
11304 Examples :
11305 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11306 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11307
11308 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11309 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011311fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11312 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011313 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11314 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011315 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11316 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11317 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11318 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11319 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011321fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11322 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11323 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11324 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11325 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11326 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11327 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11328 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11329 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011330
11331 Example :
11332 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11333 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11334 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11335 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11336 frontend mail
11337 bind :25
11338 mode tcp
11339 maxconn 100
11340 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11341 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11342 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11343 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011344
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011345nbproc : integer
11346 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11347 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11348 and debugging purposes.
11349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011350nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11351 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11352 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11353 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011354 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11355 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11356 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011357
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011358proc : integer
11359 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11360 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11361 debugging purposes.
11362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011363queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011364 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11365 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11366 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011367 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11368 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11369 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11370 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11371 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11372
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011373rand([<range>]) : integer
11374 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11375 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11376 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11377 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11378 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011380srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11381 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11382 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11383 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11384 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11385 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11386 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11387 methods.
11388
11389srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11390 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11391 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11392 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11393 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11394 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11395 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11396 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11397
11398srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11399 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11400 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011401 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011402 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11403 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11404 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11405 overloading servers).
11406
11407 Example :
11408 # Redirect to a separate back
11409 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11410 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11411 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11412
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011413stopping : boolean
11414 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11415 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11416 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011418table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11419 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11420 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11421
11422table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11423 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11424 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11425 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11426
11427
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200114287.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011429----------------------------------
11430
11431The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11432closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11433methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11434sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11435TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011436the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11437counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11438"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011439argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11440the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11441this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011442
11443be_id : integer
11444 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11445 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11446
11447dst : ip
11448 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11449 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11450 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11451 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11452 RFC 4291.
11453
11454dst_conn : integer
11455 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11456 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11457 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11458 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11459 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11460 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11461 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11462 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011464dst_port : integer
11465 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11466 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11467 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11468 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11469 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11470 an HTTP header.
11471
11472fe_id : integer
11473 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11474 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11475 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11476
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011477sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011478sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11479sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11480sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011481 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11482 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11483 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11484
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011485sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011486sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11487sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11488sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011489 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11490 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11491 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11492
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011493sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011494sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11495sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11496sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011497 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11498 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011499 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11500 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11501 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011502
11503 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11504 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011505 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11506 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11507 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011508 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11509 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11510
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011511sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011512sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11513sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11514sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011515 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11516 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11517
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011518sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011519sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11520sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11521sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011522 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11523 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11524 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11525
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011526sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011527sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11528sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11529sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011530 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11531 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11532 See also src_conn_rate.
11533
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011534sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011535sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11536sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11537sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011538 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011539 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011540
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011541sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011542sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11543sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11544sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011545 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11546 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11547 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011548 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11549 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11550 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011551
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011552sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011553sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11554sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11555sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011556 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11557 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11558 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11559
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011560sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011561sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11562sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11563sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011564 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11565 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11566 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11567 src_http_err_rate.
11568
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011569sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011570sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11571sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11572sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011573 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11574 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11575 src_http_req_cnt.
11576
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011577sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011578sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11579sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11580sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011581 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11582 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11583 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11584 src_http_req_rate.
11585
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011586sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011587sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11588sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11589sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011590 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011591 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11592 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11593 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11594 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011595
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011596 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11597 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011598 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11599
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011600sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011601sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11602sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11603sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011604 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11605 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11606 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011607
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011608sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011609sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11610sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11611sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011612 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11613 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11614 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011615
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011616sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011617sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11618sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11619sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011620 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11621 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11622 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11623 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011624 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011625 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11626
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011627sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011628sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11629sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11630sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011631 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11632 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11633 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11634 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11635 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011636 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011637
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011638sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011639sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11640sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11641sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011642 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11643 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11644 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11645
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011646sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011647sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11648sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11649sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011650 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11651 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011652 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011653 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11654 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011655 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11656 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11657 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011659so_id : integer
11660 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11661 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11662 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011664src : ip
11665 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11666 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11667 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11668 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11669 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11670 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11671 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011672
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011673 Example:
11674 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11675 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011677src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11678 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11679 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11680 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011681 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011683src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11684 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11685 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011686 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011687 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011689src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11690 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11691 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11692 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11693 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11694 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11695 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011696
11697 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11698 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11699 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11700 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011701 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011702 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11703 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011705src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011706 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011707 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011708 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011709 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011711src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011712 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011713 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11714 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011715 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011717src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11718 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11719 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11720 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011721 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011723src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011724 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011725 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011726 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011727 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011729src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011730 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011731 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011732 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11733 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011734 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11735 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11736 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011738src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11739 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11740 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011741 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011742 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011743 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011745src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11746 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11747 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11748 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11749 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011750 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011752src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11753 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11754 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11755 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011756 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011758src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11759 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11760 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11761 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011762 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011763 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011765src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11766 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11767 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11768 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011769 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011770 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11771 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011772
11773 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011774 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011775 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011777src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011778 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11779 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11780 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11781 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11782 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011784src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011785 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11786 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11787 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11788 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11789 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011791src_port : integer
11792 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11793 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11794 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11795 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011797src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11798 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011799 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11800 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11801 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011802 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011804src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11805 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11806 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11807 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11808 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011809 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011811src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11812 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11813 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11814 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11815 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11816 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11817 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11818 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11819 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011820
11821 Example :
11822 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11823 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11824 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11825 listen ssh
11826 bind :22
11827 mode tcp
11828 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011829 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011830 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011831 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011833srv_id : integer
11834 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11835 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11836 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011837
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011838
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200118397.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011840----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011842The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11843closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11844when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11845usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011846future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011847
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011848ssl_bc : boolean
11849 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11850 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11851 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11852
11853ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11854 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11855 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11856
11857ssl_bc_cipher : string
11858 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11859 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11860
11861ssl_bc_protocol : string
11862 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11863 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11864
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011865ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011866 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011867 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11868 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011869
11870ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11871 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11872 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11873 if session was reused or not.
11874
11875ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11876 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11877 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011879ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11880 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11881 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11882 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11883 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11884 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011886ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11887 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11888 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11889 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11890 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011891
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011892ssl_c_der : binary
11893 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11894 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11895 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011897ssl_c_err : integer
11898 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11899 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11900 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11901 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11902 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011904ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11905 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11906 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11907 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11908 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11909 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11910 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11911 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11912 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011914ssl_c_key_alg : string
11915 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11916 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11917 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011919ssl_c_notafter : string
11920 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11921 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11922 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011924ssl_c_notbefore : string
11925 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11926 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11927 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011929ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11930 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11931 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11932 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11933 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11934 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11935 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11936 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11937 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011939ssl_c_serial : binary
11940 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11941 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11942 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011944ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11945 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11946 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11947 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011948 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11949 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11950
11951 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011953ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11954 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11955 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11956 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011958ssl_c_used : boolean
11959 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11960 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011962ssl_c_verify : integer
11963 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11964 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11965 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11966 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011968ssl_c_version : integer
11969 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11970 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011971
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011972ssl_f_der : binary
11973 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11974 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11975 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011977ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11978 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11979 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11980 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11981 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011982 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011983 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11984 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11985 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011987ssl_f_key_alg : string
11988 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11989 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11990 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011992ssl_f_notafter : string
11993 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11994 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11995 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011997ssl_f_notbefore : string
11998 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11999 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12000 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012002ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12003 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12004 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12005 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12006 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12007 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12008 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12009 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12010 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012012ssl_f_serial : binary
12013 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12014 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12015 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012016
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020012017ssl_f_sha1 : binary
12018 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
12019 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
12020 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
12021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012022ssl_f_sig_alg : string
12023 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12024 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12025 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012027ssl_f_version : integer
12028 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12029 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12030
12031ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012032 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12033 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
12034 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
12035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012036 Example :
12037 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
12038 listen http-https
12039 bind :80
12040 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12041 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12042
12043ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12044 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12045 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12046
12047ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012048 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012049 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12050 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12051 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12052 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12053 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12054 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12055 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12056 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012058ssl_fc_cipher : string
12059 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12060 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012062ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012063 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
12064 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010012065 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
12066 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
12067 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
12068 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012070ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
12071 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020012072 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
12073 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
12074 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12075 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012076
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020012077ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
12078 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
12079 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
12080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012081ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012082 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012083 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
12084 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
12085 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12086 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
12087 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
12088 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
12089 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020012090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012091ssl_fc_protocol : string
12092 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
12093 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012094
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012095ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012096 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012097 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12098 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012100ssl_fc_session_id : binary
12101 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
12102 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
12103 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
12104 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012106ssl_fc_sni : string
12107 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
12108 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
12109 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
12110 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
12111 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
12112
12113 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
12114 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
12115 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020012116 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12117 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012119 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012120 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
12121 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020012122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012123ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
12124 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
12125 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012126
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012127
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200121287.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012129------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012131Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
12132sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
12133only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
12134For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
12135be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
12136can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
12137sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
12138for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
12139content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012141payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
12142 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
12143 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
12144 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012146payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
12147 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
12148 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
12149 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012151req.len : integer
12152req_len : integer (deprecated)
12153 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12154 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12155 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12156 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12157 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12158 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12159 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
12160 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012162req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12163 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012164 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12165 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12166 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12167 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012169 ACL alternatives :
12170 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012172req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12173 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12174 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12175 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
12176 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012178 ACL alternatives :
12179 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012181 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012183req.proto_http : boolean
12184req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
12185 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
12186 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
12187 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
12188 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
12189 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
12190 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
12191 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012193 Example:
12194 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12195 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12196 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012197 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012199req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
12200rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12201 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
12202 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
12203 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
12204 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
12205 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
12206 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
12207 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012209 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
12210 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
12211 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
12212 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
12213 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
12214 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012216 ACL derivatives :
12217 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012219 Example :
12220 listen tse-farm
12221 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
12222 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
12223 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12224 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
12225 # apply RDP cookie persistence
12226 persist rdp-cookie
12227 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
12228 # This is only useful makes sense if
12229 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
12230 stick-table type string size 204800
12231 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
12232 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
12233 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012235 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12236 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012238req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12239rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12240 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12241 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12242 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12243 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012245 ACL derivatives :
12246 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012248req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12249req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12250 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12251 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12252 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12253 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12254 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12255 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12256 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012258req.ssl_sni : string
12259req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12260 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12261 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12262 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12263 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12264 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12265 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12266 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12267 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12268 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12269 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12270 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12271 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012273 ACL derivatives :
12274 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012276 Examples :
12277 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12278 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12279 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12280 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12281 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012283res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12284rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12285 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12286 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12287 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12288 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12289 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12290 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12291 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012293req.ssl_ver : integer
12294req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12295 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12296 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12297 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12298 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12299 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12300 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12301 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12302 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12303 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012305 ACL derivatives :
12306 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012307
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012308res.len : integer
12309 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12310 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12311 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12312 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12313 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12314 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12315 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12316 content inspection.
12317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012318res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12319 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012320 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12321 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12322 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12323 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012325res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12326 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12327 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12328 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12329 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012331 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012333wait_end : boolean
12334 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12335 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12336 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12337 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12338 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12339 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12340 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12341 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012343 Examples :
12344 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12345 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12346 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012348 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12349 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12350 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12351 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12352 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12353 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12354 tcp-request content reject
12355
12356
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200123577.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012358--------------------------------------
12359
12360It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12361This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12362data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12363its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12364HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12365content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12366to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12367more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12368response are indexed.
12369
12370base : string
12371 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12372 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12373 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12374 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12375 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12376 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12377 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12378 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12379
12380 ACL derivatives :
12381 base : exact string match
12382 base_beg : prefix match
12383 base_dir : subdir match
12384 base_dom : domain match
12385 base_end : suffix match
12386 base_len : length match
12387 base_reg : regex match
12388 base_sub : substring match
12389
12390base32 : integer
12391 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12392 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12393 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012394 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12395 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12396 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012397
12398base32+src : binary
12399 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12400 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12401 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12402 per-URL counters.
12403
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012404capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12405 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12406 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12407 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12408
12409capture.req.method : string
12410 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12411 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12412 because it's allocated.
12413
12414capture.req.uri : string
12415 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12416 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12417 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12418 allocated.
12419
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012420capture.req.ver : string
12421 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12422 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12423 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12424
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012425capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12426 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12427 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12428 The first entry is an index of 0.
12429 See also: "capture response header"
12430
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012431capture.res.ver : string
12432 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12433 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12434 persistent flag.
12435
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012436req.body : binary
12437 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
12438 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12439 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
12440 the first chunk is analyzed.
12441
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020012442req.body_param([<name>) : string
12443 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
12444 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
12445 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
12446 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
12447 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
12448 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
12449 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
12450 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
12451 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
12452 given.
12453
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012454req.body_len : integer
12455 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
12456 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
12457 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12458 "option http-buffer-request".
12459
12460req.body_size : integer
12461 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
12462 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
12463 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
12464 that the request body has been buffered made available using
12465 "option http-buffer-request".
12466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012467req.cook([<name>]) : string
12468cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12469 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12470 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12471 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12472 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12473 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12474 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12475 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12476 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12477
12478 ACL derivatives :
12479 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12480 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12481 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12482 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12483 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12484 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12485 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12486 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012488req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12489cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12490 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12491 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012493req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12494cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12495 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12496 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12497 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12498 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012500cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12501 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12502 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12503 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12504 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12505 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12506 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12507 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12508 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12509 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12510 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012512hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12513 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12514 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12515 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12516 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012517 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012519req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12520 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12521 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12522 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12523 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12524 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12525 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12526 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12527 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012529req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12530 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12531 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12532 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12533 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012535req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12536 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12537 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12538 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12539 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12540 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12541 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12542 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12543 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12544 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12545 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12546 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012548 ACL derivatives :
12549 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12550 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12551 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12552 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12553 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12554 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12555 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12556 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12557
12558req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12559hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12560 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12561 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12562 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12563 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12564 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12565 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12566 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12567 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12568 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12569
12570req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12571hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12572 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12573 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12574 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12575 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12576 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12577 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12578 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12579 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12580
12581req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12582hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12583 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12584 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12585 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12586 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12587 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12588 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12589 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12590
12591http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12592 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12593 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12594 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12595 basic auth is supported.
12596
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012597http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12598 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12599 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12600 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12601 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012602 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12603 basic auth is supported.
12604
12605 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012606 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12607 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12608 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12609 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012610
12611http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012612 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12613 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012614 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12615 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012617method : integer + string
12618 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12619 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12620 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12621 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12622 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12623 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12624 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012626 ACL derivatives :
12627 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012629 Example :
12630 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12631 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12632 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012634path : string
12635 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12636 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12637 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12638 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12639 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12640 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12641 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012643 ACL derivatives :
12644 path : exact string match
12645 path_beg : prefix match
12646 path_dir : subdir match
12647 path_dom : domain match
12648 path_end : suffix match
12649 path_len : length match
12650 path_reg : regex match
12651 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012652
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012653query : string
12654 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12655 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12656 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12657 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12658 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12659 which stops before the question mark.
12660
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012661req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12662 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12663 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12664 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12665 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012667req.ver : string
12668req_ver : string (deprecated)
12669 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12670 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12671 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012673 ACL derivatives :
12674 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012676res.comp : boolean
12677 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12678 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12679 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012681res.comp_algo : string
12682 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12683 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12684 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012686res.cook([<name>]) : string
12687scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12688 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12689 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12690 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012692 ACL derivatives :
12693 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012695res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12696scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12697 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12698 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12699 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012701res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12702scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12703 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12704 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12705 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012707res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12708 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12709 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12710 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12711 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12712 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12713 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12714 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12715 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12716 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012718res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12719 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12720 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12721 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12722 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12723 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012725res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12726shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12727 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12728 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12729 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12730 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12731 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12732 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12733 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12734 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012736 ACL derivatives :
12737 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12738 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12739 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12740 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12741 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12742 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12743 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12744 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12745
12746res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12747shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12748 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12749 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12750 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12751 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12752 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012754res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12755shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12756 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12757 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12758 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12759 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12760 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12761 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012762
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012763res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12764 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12765 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12766 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12767 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012769res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12770shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12771 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12772 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12773 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12774 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12775 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12776 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012778res.ver : string
12779resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12780 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12781 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012783 ACL derivatives :
12784 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012786set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12787 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12788 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12789 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12790 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012792 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12793 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012795 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012797status : integer
12798 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12799 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12800 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012802url : string
12803 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12804 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12805 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12806 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12807 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12808 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12809 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012811 ACL derivatives :
12812 url : exact string match
12813 url_beg : prefix match
12814 url_dir : subdir match
12815 url_dom : domain match
12816 url_end : suffix match
12817 url_len : length match
12818 url_reg : regex match
12819 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012821url_ip : ip
12822 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12823 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12824 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12825 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12826 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12827 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12828 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012830url_port : integer
12831 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12832 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12833 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12834 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012835
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020012836urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
12837url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012838 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12839 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020012840 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
12841 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
12842 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
12843 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012844 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12845 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020012846 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
12847 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012849 ACL derivatives :
12850 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12851 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12852 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12853 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12854 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12855 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12856 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12857 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012858
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012860 Example :
12861 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12862 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12863 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12864 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012865
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020012866urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012867 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12868 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12869 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012870
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128727.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012873---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012875Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12876every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012877order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012879ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12880---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012881FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012882HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012883HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12884HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012885HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12886HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12887HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12888HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12889LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012890METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12891METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12892METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12893METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12894METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12895METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012896RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012897REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012898TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012899WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12900---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012901
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129038. Logging
12904----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012905
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012906One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12907provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12908very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12909provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12910state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012911to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012912headers.
12913
12914In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12915about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12916send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12917
12918 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12919 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12920 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12921 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12922 at the termination.
12923
12924The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12925allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12926as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12927while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12928real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12929delay.
12930
12931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129328.1. Log levels
12933---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012934
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012935TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012936source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012937HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12938in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12939track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12940syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12941about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012942
12943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129448.2. Log formats
12945----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012946
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012947HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012948and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12949slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12950options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012951
12952 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12953 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12954 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12955 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12956 extents.
12957
12958 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12959 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12960 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12961 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12962 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12963
12964 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12965 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12966 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12967 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12968 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12969
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012970 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12971 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12972 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12973 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12974
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012975 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12976
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012977Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12978specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12979field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12980servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12981always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12982identifier.
12983
12984Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12985 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12986 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12987 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12988 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12989
12990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129918.2.1. Default log format
12992-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012993
12994This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12995as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12996format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12997
12998 Example :
12999 listen www
13000 mode http
13001 log global
13002 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13003
13004 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
13005 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
13006 (www/HTTP)
13007
13008 Field Format Extract from the example above
13009 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
13010 2 'Connect from' Connect from
13011 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
13012 4 'to' to
13013 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
13014 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
13015
13016Detailed fields description :
13017 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
13018 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
13019 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
13020 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
13021 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13022 and processed the connection.
13023 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
13024
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013025In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
13026"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
13027connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
13028
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013029It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
13030will eventually disappear.
13031
13032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130338.2.2. TCP log format
13034---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013035
13036The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
13037is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
13038information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
13039counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
13040emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13041environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13042the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13043sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013044specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
13045not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
13046fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
13047marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013048
13049 Example :
13050 frontend fnt
13051 mode tcp
13052 option tcplog
13053 log global
13054 default_backend bck
13055
13056 backend bck
13057 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13058
13059 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
13060 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
13061 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
13062
13063 Field Format Extract from the example above
13064 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
13065 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
13066 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
13067 4 frontend_name fnt
13068 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
13069 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
13070 7 bytes_read* 212
13071 8 termination_state --
13072 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
13073 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13074
13075Detailed fields description :
13076 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013077 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13078 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13079 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13080 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13081 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013082
13083 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013084 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13085 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13086 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013087
13088 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
13089 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
13090 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
13091 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
13092
13093 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13094 and processed the connection.
13095
13096 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13097 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13098 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
13099 applications.
13100
13101 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13102 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13103 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13104 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
13105 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
13106
13107 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13108 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13109 See "Timers" below for more details.
13110
13111 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13112 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13113 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
13114 "Timers" below for more details.
13115
13116 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013117 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013118 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13119 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13120 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13121 details.
13122
13123 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
13124 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
13125 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
13126 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
13127 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
13128
13129 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13130 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13131 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
13132 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
13133 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
13134 for more details.
13135
13136 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013137 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013138 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
13139 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
13140 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013141 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013142
13143 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13144 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13145 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13146 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13147 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13148 caused by a denial of service attack.
13149
13150 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13151 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13152 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13153 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13154 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13155 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13156 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13157 denial of service attack.
13158
13159 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13160 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13161 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13162 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13163 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13164 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13165 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13166 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
13167 be processed than on other servers.
13168
13169 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13170 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13171 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13172 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13173 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13174 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13175 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13176 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13177 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13178 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13179 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13180 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13181 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13182
13183 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13184 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13185 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13186 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13187 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13188 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13189 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13190 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13191
13192 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13193 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13194 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13195 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13196 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13197 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13198 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13199 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13200 occurs.
13201
13202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132038.2.3. HTTP log format
13204----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013205
13206The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
13207is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
13208the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
13209are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
13210emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
13211generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
13212"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
13213which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013214frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
13215is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013216
13217Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
13218slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
13219with a star ('*') after the field name below.
13220
13221 Example :
13222 frontend http-in
13223 mode http
13224 option httplog
13225 log global
13226 default_backend bck
13227
13228 backend static
13229 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13230
13231 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
13232 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
13233 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013234 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013235
13236 Field Format Extract from the example above
13237 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
13238 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
13239 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
13240 4 frontend_name http-in
13241 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
13242 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
13243 7 status_code 200
13244 8 bytes_read* 2750
13245 9 captured_request_cookie -
13246 10 captured_response_cookie -
13247 11 termination_state ----
13248 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
13249 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13250 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
13251 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
13252 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013253
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013254
13255Detailed fields description :
13256 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013257 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13258 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13259 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13260 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13261 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013262
13263 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013264 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13265 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13266 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013267
13268 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13269 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13270 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13271 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13272 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13273
13274 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13275 and processed the connection.
13276
13277 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13278 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13279 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13280
13281 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13282 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13283 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13284 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13285 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13286 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13287
13288 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13289 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13290 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13291 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13292 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13293 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13294
13295 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13296 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13297 See "Timers" below for more details.
13298
13299 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13300 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13301 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13302 below for more details.
13303
13304 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13305 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13306 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13307 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13308 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13309 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13310 for more details.
13311
13312 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013313 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013314 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13315 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13316 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13317 details.
13318
13319 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13320 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13321 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13322
13323 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13324 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13325 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13326 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13327 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13328 overflowing.
13329
13330 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13331 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13332 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13333 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13334 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13335 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13336 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13337 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13338
13339 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13340 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13341 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13342 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13343 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13344 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13345 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13346 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13347
13348 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13349 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13350 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13351 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13352 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13353 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13354 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13355
13356 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013357 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013358 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13359 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13360 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013361 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013362 system.
13363
13364 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13365 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13366 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13367 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13368 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13369 caused by a denial of service attack.
13370
13371 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13372 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13373 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13374 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13375 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13376 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13377 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13378 denial of service attack.
13379
13380 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13381 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13382 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13383 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13384 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13385 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13386 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13387 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13388 processed than on other servers.
13389
13390 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13391 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13392 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13393 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13394 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13395 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13396 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13397 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13398 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13399 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13400 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13401 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13402 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13403
13404 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13405 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13406 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13407 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13408 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13409 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13410 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13411 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13412
13413 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13414 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13415 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13416 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13417 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13418 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13419 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13420 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13421 occurs.
13422
13423 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13424 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13425 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13426 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13427 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13428 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13429 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13430 cookies" below for more details.
13431
13432 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13433 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13434 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13435 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13436 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13437 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13438 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13439 and cookies" below for more details.
13440
13441 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13442 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13443 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13444 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13445 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13446 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13447 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13448 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13449
13450
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200134518.2.4. Custom log format
13452------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013453
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013454The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013455mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013456
13457HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13458Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13459separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13460prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13461
13462Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13463variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13464string formats ("Q").
13465
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013466If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013467as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013468less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13469the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13470
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013471Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013472In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013473in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013474
13475Flags are :
13476 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013477 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013478
13479 Example:
13480
13481 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13482 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13483
13484At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13485
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013486 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13487 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013488
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013489the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013490
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013491 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013492 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013493 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013494
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013495and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13496
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013497 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013498 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13499
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013500Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13501
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013502 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013503 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013504 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13505 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13506 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013507 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13508 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13509 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013510 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000013511 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
13512 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
13513 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
13514 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013515 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013516 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013517 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013518 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013519 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013520 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13521 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013522 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013523 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13524 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013525 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013526 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13527 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013528 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13529 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13530 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013531 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013532 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13533 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013534 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013535 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13536 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13537 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013538 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013539 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013540 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13541 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13542 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13543 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013544 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013545 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013546 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013547 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013548 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013549 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013550 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13551 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13552 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013553 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013554 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13555 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013556 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013557 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013558 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013559 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013560
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013561 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013562
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013563
135648.2.5. Error log format
13565-----------------------
13566
13567When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13568protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13569By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13570"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13571will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13572logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13573
13574The format looks like this :
13575
13576 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13577 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13578 Connection error during SSL handshake
13579
13580 Field Format Extract from the example above
13581 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13582 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13583 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13584 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13585 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13586
13587These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13588failures.
13589
13590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135918.3. Advanced logging options
13592-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013593
13594Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13595just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13596options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13597for more information about their usage.
13598
13599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13601------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013602
13603It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13604haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13605commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13606monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13607ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13608
13609 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13610 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13611 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13612 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13613
13614 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13615 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13616 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013617 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013618 such as other load-balancers.
13619
13620 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13621 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13622 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13623
13624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136258.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13626----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013627
13628The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13629what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13630or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13631"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13632just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13633log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13634after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13635is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13636with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13637with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13638
13639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136408.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13641------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013642
13643Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13644for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13645"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13646retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13647raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13648a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13649file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13650you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13651"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13652
13653
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136548.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13655--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013656
13657Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13658multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13659them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13660"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13661logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13662error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13663and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13664too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13665useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13666alternative.
13667
13668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136698.4. Timing events
13670------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013671
13672Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13673reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13674the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13675frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13676mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13677
13678 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13679 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13680 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13681 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13682 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13683
13684 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13685 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13686 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13687 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13688 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13689
13690 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13691 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13692 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13693 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13694 connection never established.
13695
13696 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13697 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13698 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13699 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13700 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13701 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13702 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13703 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13704 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13705 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13706 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13707
13708 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13709 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13710 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13711 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013712 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013713
13714 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13715
13716 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13717 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13718 negative.
13719
13720These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13721protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13722that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013723due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013724close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13725session has been aborted on timeout.
13726
13727Most common cases :
13728
13729 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13730 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13731 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13732 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13733 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13734 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13735 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13736 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13737 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013738 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13739 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13740 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013741
13742 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13743 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13744 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13745 of ms on remote networks.
13746
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013747 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13748 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13749 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013750
13751 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13752 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13753 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13754 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13755 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13756 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13757 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13758 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13759 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13760 to the server until another one is released.
13761
13762Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13763
13764 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13765 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13766 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13767
13768 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13769 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13770 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13771
13772 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13773 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13774 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13775 flags.
13776
13777 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13778 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13779 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13780 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13781 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13782 the client connection was maintained open.
13783
13784 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013785 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013786 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13787 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13788
13789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137908.5. Session state at disconnection
13791-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013792
13793TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13794"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
137952-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13796each of which has a special meaning :
13797
13798 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13799 session to terminate :
13800
13801 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13802
13803 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13804 server explicitly refused it.
13805
13806 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13807 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13808 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13809 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013810 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13811
13812 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13813 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013814
13815 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13816 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13817 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13818 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13819 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13820
13821 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13822 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13823 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13824 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13825 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13826
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013827 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13828 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13829
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013830 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13831 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13832 backup connections when going up.
13833
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013834 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13835
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013836 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13837 send or receive data.
13838
13839 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13840 send or receive data.
13841
13842 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13843 with nothing left in the buffers.
13844
13845 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13846
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013847 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013848 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13849
13850 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13851 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13852 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13853 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13854 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13855
13856 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13857 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13858
13859 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13860 server (HTTP only).
13861
13862 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13863
13864 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13865 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13866 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13867
13868 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13869 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13870 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13871
13872 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13873
13874 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13875 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13876
13877 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13878 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13879 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13880
13881 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13882 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013883 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13884 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013885
13886 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13887 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13888 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13889 another server.
13890
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013891 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013892 server.
13893
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013894 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13895 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13896 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13897 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13898
13899 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13900 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13901 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13902 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13903
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013904 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13905 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13906 "use-server" rule).
13907
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013908 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13909
13910 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13911 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13912
13913 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13914
13915 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13916 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13917 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13918
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013919 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13920 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013921 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013922 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13923 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13924
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013925 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13926
13927 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13928 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13929
13930 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13931
13932 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13933
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013934The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13935was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013936helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13937starvation, attacks, etc...
13938
13939The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13940alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13941easier finding and understanding.
13942
13943 Flags Reason
13944
13945 -- Normal termination.
13946
13947 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13948 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13949 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13950 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13951
13952 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13953 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13954 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13955 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13956 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13957 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013958
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013959 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13960 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013961 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013962
13963 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13964 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13965 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13966
13967 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13968 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13969 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13970 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13971 the server takes too long to respond.
13972
13973 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13974 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13975 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13976 long a time to respond.
13977
13978 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13979 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13980 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13981 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013982 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
13983 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013984
13985 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13986 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13987 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13988 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13989 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013990 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013991 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
13992 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
13993 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
13994 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
13995 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
13996 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
13997 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
13998 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
13999 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
14000 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
14001 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
14002 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014003
14004 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
14005 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014006 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
14007 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
14008 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
14009 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014010
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014011 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
14012 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
14013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014014 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014015 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
14016 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
14017 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
14018 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
14019 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
14020
14021 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
14022 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
14023 503 or 504 here.
14024
14025 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
14026 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
14027 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
14028 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
14029 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
14030
14031 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14032 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014033 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014034 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
14035 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
14036
14037 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
14038 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
14039 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
14040 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14041 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14042 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14043 between haproxy and the server.
14044
14045 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
14046 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
14047 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
14048 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
14049 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
14050 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
14051 solution is to fix the application.
14052
14053 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
14054 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
14055 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
14056 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
14057 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
14058 external attacks.
14059
14060 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
14061 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014062 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014063 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
14064 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
14065
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014066 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
14067 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
14068 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020014069 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
14070 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014071
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014072 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
14073 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
14074 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
14075 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014076 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
14077 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
14078 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
14079 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
14080 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014081
14082 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
14083 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
14084 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
14085 returned an HTTP 403 error.
14086
14087 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
14088 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
14089 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
14090 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
14091
14092 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
14093 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
14094 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
14095 only be solved by proper system tuning.
14096
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014097The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
14098persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
14099important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
14100re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
14101
14102 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
14103
14104 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14105 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
14106 set on a GET request.
14107
14108 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
14109 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014110 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014111 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
14112
14113 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
14114 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
14115 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
14116
14117 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14118 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
14119 already got a cookie.
14120
14121 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14122 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
14123 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
14124 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
14125 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
14126
14127 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14128 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14129 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14130
14131 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
14132 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14133 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14134
14135 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
14136 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
14137
14138 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
14139 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
14140 then advertised in the response.
14141
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141438.6. Non-printable characters
14144-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014145
14146In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
14147consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
14148converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
14149prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
14150being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
14151escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
14152is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
14153'}' when logging headers.
14154
14155Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
14156issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
14157containing spaces is "User-Agent".
14158
14159Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
14160the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
14161performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
14162
14163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141648.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
14165---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014166
14167Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
14168achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014169section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014170cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
14171the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
14172the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014173locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014174not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
14175user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
14176a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
14177wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
14178
14179 Examples :
14180 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
14181 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
14182
14183 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
14184 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
14185
14186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
14188---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014189
14190Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
14191proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
14192the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
14193server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
14194
14195Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
14196response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014197section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014198
14199It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014200time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
14201appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014202are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
14203and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
14204follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
14205request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
14206in the logs.
14207
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014208As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
14209frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
14210an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
14211
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014212 Example :
14213 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
14214 listen proxy-out
14215 mode http
14216 option httplog
14217 option logasap
14218 log global
14219 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
14220
14221 # log the name of the virtual server
14222 capture request header Host len 20
14223
14224 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
14225 capture request header Content-Length len 10
14226
14227 # log the beginning of the referrer
14228 capture request header Referer len 20
14229
14230 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
14231 capture response header Server len 20
14232
14233 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
14234 capture response header Content-Length len 10
14235
14236 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
14237 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
14238
14239 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
14240 capture response header Via len 20
14241
14242 # log the URL location during a redirection
14243 capture response header Location len 20
14244
14245 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
14246 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
14247 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14248 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
14249 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
14250
14251 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14252 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14253 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14254 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014255 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014256
14257 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14258 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14259 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14260 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
14261 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014262 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014263
14264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142658.9. Examples of logs
14266---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014267
14268These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14269them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14270reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14271
14272 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14273 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14274 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14275
14276 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14277 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14278
14279 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14280 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14281 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14282
14283 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14284 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14285
14286 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14287 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14288 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14289
14290 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014291 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014292 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14293 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14294
14295 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14296 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14297 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14298
14299 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14300 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014301 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014302 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14303 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14304 to return the 502 and not the server.
14305
14306 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014307 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014308
14309 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14310 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14311 Nothing was sent to any server.
14312
14313 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14314 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14315
14316 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14317 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14318 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14319 send a 408 return code to the client.
14320
14321 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14322 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14323
14324 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14325 5 seconds ("c----").
14326
14327 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14328 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014329 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014330
14331 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014332 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014333 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14334 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14335 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14336 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14337 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014338
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143409. Statistics and monitoring
14341----------------------------
14342
14343It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14344mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14345CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14346Unix socket.
14347
14348
143499.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014350---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014351
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014352The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014353page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14354begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14355represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14356use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14357('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14358(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14359text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14360do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14361use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014362
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014363In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14364that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14365S (Servers).
14366
14367 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14368 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14369 any name for server/listener)
14370 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14371 number queued without a server assigned.
14372 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14373 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14374 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14375 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14376 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14377 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14378 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14379 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14380 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14381 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14382 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14383 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14384 "option checkcache".
14385 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14386 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14387 - read error from the client
14388 - client timeout
14389 - client closed connection
14390 - various bad requests from the client.
14391 - request was tarpitted.
14392 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14393 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14394 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14395 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14396 active servers).
14397 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14398 Some other errors are:
14399 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14400 - failure applying filters to the response.
14401 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14402 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14403 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14404 switched away from.
14405 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissis1f673c72015-05-02 20:30:44 +020014406 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
14407 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
14408 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014409 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14410 the server is up.)
14411 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14412 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14413 counters for each server.
14414 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14415 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14416 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14417 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14418 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14419 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14420 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14421 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14422 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14423 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14424 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14425 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14426 of times that server was selected.
14427 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14428 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14429 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14430 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14431 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14432 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014433 UNK -> unknown
14434 INI -> initializing
14435 SOCKERR -> socket error
14436 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014437 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014438 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14439 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14440 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14441 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14442 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14443 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14444 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14445 disable-on-404
14446 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14447 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14448 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014449 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14450 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14451 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14452 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14453 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14454 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14455 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14456 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14457 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14458 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14459 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14460 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14461 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14462 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14463 (inc. in eresp)
14464 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14465 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14466 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14467 (CPU/BW limit)
14468 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14469 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14470 server/backend
14471 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14472 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14473 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14474 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14475 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14476 (0 for TCP)
14477 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14478 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014479
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144819.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014482-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014483
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014484The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14485necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14486A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14487issuing commands by hand :
14488
14489 global
14490 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14491 stats timeout 2m
14492
14493It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14494the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14495never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14496situations :
14497
14498 global
14499 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14500 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14501 stats timeout 2m
14502
14503To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14504swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14505to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14506syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14507
14508 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14509 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14510
14511The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14512script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14513for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14514
14515The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14516that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14517editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14518(eg: watch a counter).
14519
14520The socket supports two operation modes :
14521 - interactive
14522 - non-interactive
14523
14524The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14525this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14526sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14527mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14528commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14529example :
14530
14531 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14532
14533The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14534entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14535for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14536sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14537"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14538after processing the last command of the same line.
14539
14540For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14541"prompt" command :
14542
14543 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14544 prompt
14545 > show info
14546 ...
14547 >
14548
14549Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14550delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14551that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14552parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014553
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014554It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14555on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14556own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014557
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014558The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14559If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14560all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14561it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14562
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014563add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014564 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14565 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14566 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14567 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014568
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014569add map <map> <key> <value>
14570 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14571 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014572 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14573 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14574 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014575
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014576clear counters
14577 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14578 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14579 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14580 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14581 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14582
14583clear counters all
14584 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14585 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14586 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14587
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014588clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014589 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14590 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14591 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014592
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014593clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014594 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14595 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14596 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014597
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014598clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14599 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14600
14601 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14602 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14603 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14604 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14605 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14606 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14607
14608 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14609
14610 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14611 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14612 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14613 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14614 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14615 the ACLs :
14616
14617 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14618 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14619 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14620 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14621 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14622 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14623
14624 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014625 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14626 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014627
14628 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014629 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014630 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014631 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14632 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14633 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14634 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014635
14636 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14637
14638 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014639 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014640 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14641 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014642 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14643 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14644 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014645
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014646del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14647 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014648 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14649 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14650 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14651 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014652
14653del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014654 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014655 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14656 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14657 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14658 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014659
14660disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014661 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14662
14663 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14664 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14665 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14666 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14667 re-enabled using enable agent.
14668
14669 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14670 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14671 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14672 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14673 otherwise unchanged.
14674
14675 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14676 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14677 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14678
14679 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14680 level "admin".
14681
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014682disable frontend <frontend>
14683 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14684 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14685 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14686 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14687 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14688 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14689 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14690 on the stats page.
14691
14692 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14693 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14694
14695 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14696 level "admin".
14697
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014698disable health <backend>/<server>
14699 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14700 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14701 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14702 agent check forces it down.
14703
14704 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14705 level "admin".
14706
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014707disable server <backend>/<server>
14708 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14709 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14710 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14711 during the maintenance.
14712
14713 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14714 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14715
14716 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014717 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014718
14719 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14720 level "admin".
14721
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014722enable agent <backend>/<server>
14723 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14724
14725 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14726 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14727
14728 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14729 level "admin".
14730
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014731enable frontend <frontend>
14732 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14733 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14734 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14735 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14736 which was disabled.
14737
14738 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14739 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14740
14741 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14742 level "admin".
14743
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014744enable health <backend>/<server>
14745 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14746 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14747
14748 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14749 level "admin".
14750
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014751enable server <backend>/<server>
14752 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14753 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14754
14755 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014756 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014757
14758 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14759 level "admin".
14760
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014761get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014762get acl <acl> <value>
14763 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14764 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14765 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14766 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14767 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014768
14769 The first two words are:
14770
14771 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14772 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14773 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14774
14775 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14776
14777 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14778
14779 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14780
14781 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14782 interpretation of the case.
14783
14784 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14785 useful with regular expressions.
14786
14787 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14788 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14789
14790 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14791 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14792 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14793
14794 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14795
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014796get weight <backend>/<server>
14797 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14798 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14799 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14800 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14801 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014802 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014803
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014804help
14805 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14806 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014807
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014808prompt
14809 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14810 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14811 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14812 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14813 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14814 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14815 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14816 command.
14817
14818quit
14819 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014820
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014821set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014822 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14823 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14824 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014825
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014826set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014827 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14828 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14829 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14830 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14831 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014832 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14833 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14834
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014835set maxconn global <maxconn>
14836 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14837 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14838 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14839 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14840 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14841 setting.
14842
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014843set rate-limit connections global <value>
14844 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14845 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14846 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14847 is passed in number of connections per second.
14848
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014849set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14850 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14851 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014852 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14853 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014854
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014855set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14856 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14857 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14858 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14859 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14860
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014861set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14862 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14863 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14864 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14865 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14866 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14867
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014868set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14869 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14870 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14871 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14872
14873set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14874 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14875 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14876 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14877
14878set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14879 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14880 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14881 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14882 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14883 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14884 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14885 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14886 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14887
14888set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14889 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14890 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14891
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014892set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14893 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14894 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14895 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14896 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14897
14898 Example:
14899 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14900 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14901 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14902 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14903
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020014904set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
14905 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
14906 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
14907 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
14908 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
14909 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
14910
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014911set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014912 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14913 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14914 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14915 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014916 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14917 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014918
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014919set timeout cli <delay>
14920 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14921 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14922 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14923
14924set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14925 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14926 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014927 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14928 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14929 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14930 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14931 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14932 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14933 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14934 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14935 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14936 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14937 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14938 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14939 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014940
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014941show errors [<iid>]
14942 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14943 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014944 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14945 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14946 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014947
14948 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14949 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14950 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14951 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14952 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14953 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14954 are reported too.
14955
14956 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14957 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14958 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14959 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14960 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14961 code.
14962
14963 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14964 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14965 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14966 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14967 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14968 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14969 line.
14970
14971 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014972 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14973 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014974 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14975 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14976
14977 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14978 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14979 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14980 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14981 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14982 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14983 00204+ minal\r\n
14984 00211 \r\n
14985
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014986 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014987 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14988 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14989 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14990 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14991 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14992 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014993
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014994show info
14995 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14996
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014997show map [<map>]
14998 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014999 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
15000 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
15001 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
15002 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
15003 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
15004 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015005
15006show acl [<acl>]
15007 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015008 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
15009 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
15010 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
15011 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
15012 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015013
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010015014show pools
15015 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
15016 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
15017 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
15018 the pools.
15019
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015020show sess
15021 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015022 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
15023 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15024
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010015025show sess <id>
15026 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
15027 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15028 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
15029 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
15030 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020015031 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
15032 returned in src/dumpstats.c
15033
15034 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
15035 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015036
15037show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
15038 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
15039 possible to dump only selected items :
15040 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
15041 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
15042 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
15043 for example:
15044 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
15045 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
15046 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
15047
15048 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015049 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
15050 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015051 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
15052 Release_date: 2009/09/23
15053 Nbproc: 1
15054 Process_num: 1
15055 (...)
15056
15057 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
15058 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
15059 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
15060 (...)
15061 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
15062
15063 $
15064
15065 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
15066 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
15067 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
15068 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015069 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015070
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015071show table
15072 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
15073 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
15074 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
15075 entries currently in use.
15076
15077 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015078 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015079 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
15080 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015081
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015082show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015083 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
15084 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
15085 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015086 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
15087
15088 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
15089 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
15090 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
15091 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
15092 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
15093
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015094 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15095 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15096 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15097 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15098 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15099 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15100
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015101
15102 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015103 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
15104 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015105
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015106 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015107 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015108 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015109 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15110 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15111 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15112 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015113
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015114 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015115 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015116 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15117 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015118
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015119 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
15120 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015121 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015122 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15123 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015124
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015125 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
15126 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015127 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015128 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15129 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
15130
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015131 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
15132 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
15133 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
15134 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
15135 time goes, the average event rate drops.
15136
15137 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
15138 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
15139 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015140 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
15141 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015142 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
15143 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020015144
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015145show tls-keys
15146 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
15147 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
15148 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
15149
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015150shutdown frontend <frontend>
15151 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
15152 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
15153 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
15154 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
15155 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
15156 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
15157 once it is terminated.
15158
15159 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15160 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15161
15162 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15163 level "admin".
15164
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020015165shutdown session <id>
15166 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
15167 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15168 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
15169 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
15170 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
15171 flag in the logs.
15172
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020015173shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015174 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
15175 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
15176 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
15177 'K' flag in the logs.
15178
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015179/*
15180 * Local variables:
15181 * fill-column: 79
15182 * End:
15183 */